1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@c Copyright (C) 1988,89,92,93,94,96,97,1998 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@c This is part of the GCC manual.
|
|
|
|
@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Target Macros
|
|
|
|
@chapter Target Description Macros
|
|
|
|
@cindex machine description macros
|
|
|
|
@cindex target description macros
|
|
|
|
@cindex macros, target description
|
|
|
|
@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
|
|
|
|
includes a C header file conventionally given the name
|
|
|
|
@file{@var{machine}.h}. This header file defines numerous macros
|
|
|
|
that convey the information about the target machine that does not fit
|
|
|
|
into the scheme of the @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be
|
|
|
|
a link to @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h}
|
|
|
|
includes @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include
|
|
|
|
@file{config.h}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
|
|
* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
|
|
|
|
* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @samp{-m68000} and @samp{-m68020}.
|
|
|
|
* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
|
|
|
|
* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
|
|
|
|
* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
|
|
|
|
* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
|
|
|
|
* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
|
|
|
|
* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
|
|
|
|
* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
|
|
|
|
* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
|
|
|
|
* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
|
|
|
|
* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
|
|
|
|
* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
|
|
|
|
* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
|
|
|
|
* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
|
|
|
|
* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
|
|
|
|
* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
|
|
|
|
* Cross-compilation:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
|
|
|
|
* Misc:: Everything else.
|
|
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Driver
|
|
|
|
@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
|
|
|
|
@cindex driver
|
|
|
|
@cindex controlling the compilation driver
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
You can control the compilation driver.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
|
|
|
|
@item SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
|
|
|
|
A C expression which determines whether the option @samp{-@var{char}}
|
|
|
|
takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
|
|
|
|
option takes--zero, for many options.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
By default, this macro is defined as
|
|
|
|
@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
|
|
|
|
properly. You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
|
|
|
|
wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
|
|
|
|
should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
|
|
|
|
additional options.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
|
|
|
|
@item WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
|
|
|
|
A C expression which determines whether the option @samp{-@var{name}}
|
|
|
|
takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
|
|
|
|
option takes--zero, for many options. This macro rather than
|
|
|
|
@code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this macro is defined as
|
|
|
|
@code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
|
|
|
|
properly. You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
|
|
|
|
wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
|
|
|
|
should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
|
|
|
|
additional options.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION
|
|
|
|
@item SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION (@var{char})
|
|
|
|
A C expression which determines whether the option @samp{-@var{char}}
|
|
|
|
stops compilation before the generation of an executable. The value is
|
|
|
|
boolean, non-zero if the option does stop an executable from being
|
|
|
|
generated, zero otherwise.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By default, this macro is defined as
|
|
|
|
@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION}, which handles the standard
|
|
|
|
options properly. You need not define
|
|
|
|
@code{SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} unless you wish to add additional
|
|
|
|
options which affect the generation of an executable. Any redefinition
|
|
|
|
should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} and then check
|
|
|
|
for additional options.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
|
|
|
|
@item SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
A string-valued C expression which enumerates the options for which
|
|
|
|
the linker needs a space between the option and its argument.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, the default value is @code{""}.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CPP_SPEC
|
|
|
|
@item CPP_SPEC
|
|
|
|
A C string constant that tells the GNU CC driver program options to
|
|
|
|
pass to CPP. It can also specify how to translate options you
|
|
|
|
give to GNU CC into options for GNU CC to pass to the CPP.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex NO_BUILTIN_SIZE_TYPE
|
|
|
|
@item NO_BUILTIN_SIZE_TYPE
|
|
|
|
If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the builtin macro
|
|
|
|
@code{__SIZE_TYPE__}. The macro @code{__SIZE_TYPE__} must then be defined
|
|
|
|
by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This should be defined if @code{SIZE_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
|
|
|
|
which are not accessible to the preprocessor. Otherwise, it should not
|
|
|
|
be defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex NO_BUILTIN_PTRDIFF_TYPE
|
|
|
|
@item NO_BUILTIN_PTRDIFF_TYPE
|
|
|
|
If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the builtin macro
|
|
|
|
@code{__PTRDIFF_TYPE__}. The macro @code{__PTRDIFF_TYPE__} must then be
|
|
|
|
defined by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This should be defined if @code{PTRDIFF_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
|
|
|
|
which are not accessible to the preprocessor. Otherwise, it should not
|
|
|
|
be defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SIGNED_CHAR_SPEC
|
|
|
|
@item SIGNED_CHAR_SPEC
|
|
|
|
A C string constant that tells the GNU CC driver program options to
|
|
|
|
pass to CPP. By default, this macro is defined to pass the option
|
|
|
|
@samp{-D__CHAR_UNSIGNED__} to CPP if @code{char} will be treated as
|
|
|
|
@code{unsigned char} by @code{cc1}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro unless you need to override the default
|
|
|
|
definition.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CC1_SPEC
|
|
|
|
@item CC1_SPEC
|
|
|
|
A C string constant that tells the GNU CC driver program options to
|
|
|
|
pass to @code{cc1}. It can also specify how to translate options you
|
|
|
|
give to GNU CC into options for GNU CC to pass to the @code{cc1}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CC1PLUS_SPEC
|
|
|
|
@item CC1PLUS_SPEC
|
|
|
|
A C string constant that tells the GNU CC driver program options to
|
|
|
|
pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
|
|
|
|
give to GNU CC into options for GNU CC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_SPEC
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_SPEC
|
|
|
|
A C string constant that tells the GNU CC driver program options to
|
|
|
|
pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
|
|
|
|
you give to GNU CC into options for GNU CC to pass to the assembler.
|
|
|
|
See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_FINAL_SPEC
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_FINAL_SPEC
|
|
|
|
A C string constant that tells the GNU CC driver program how to
|
|
|
|
run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
|
|
|
|
Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
|
|
|
|
an example of this.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LINK_SPEC
|
|
|
|
@item LINK_SPEC
|
|
|
|
A C string constant that tells the GNU CC driver program options to
|
|
|
|
pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
|
|
|
|
give to GNU CC into options for GNU CC to pass to the linker.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LIB_SPEC
|
|
|
|
@item LIB_SPEC
|
|
|
|
Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
|
|
|
|
between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
|
|
|
|
command given to the linker.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
|
|
|
|
loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LIBGCC_SPEC
|
|
|
|
@item LIBGCC_SPEC
|
|
|
|
Another C string constant that tells the GNU CC driver program
|
|
|
|
how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
|
|
|
|
linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
|
|
|
|
the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, the GNU CC driver provides a default that
|
|
|
|
passes the string @samp{-lgcc} to the linker unless the @samp{-shared}
|
|
|
|
option is specified.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STARTFILE_SPEC
|
|
|
|
@item STARTFILE_SPEC
|
|
|
|
Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
|
|
|
|
difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
|
|
|
|
the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
|
|
|
|
standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ENDFILE_SPEC
|
|
|
|
@item ENDFILE_SPEC
|
|
|
|
Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
|
|
|
|
difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
|
|
|
|
the very end of the command given to the linker.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex EXTRA_SPECS
|
|
|
|
@item EXTRA_SPECS
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
|
|
|
|
@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
|
|
|
|
@code{CC1_SPEC}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
|
|
|
|
containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
|
|
|
|
string constant that provides the specification.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
|
|
|
|
related targets, which have various @code{..._SPECS} which are similar
|
|
|
|
to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
|
|
|
|
these definitions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
|
|
|
|
define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
|
|
|
|
used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
|
|
|
|
used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
#define EXTRA_SPECS \
|
|
|
|
@{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
#undef CPP_SPEC
|
|
|
|
#define CPP_SPEC \
|
|
|
|
"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
|
|
|
|
%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} %@{mcall-aix: -D_CALL_AIX @} \
|
|
|
|
%@{!mcall-sysv: %@{!mcall-aix: %(cpp_sysv_default) @}@} \
|
|
|
|
%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
|
|
|
|
#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
|
|
|
|
@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
|
|
|
|
#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
|
|
|
|
@item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
|
|
|
|
@file{libgcc.a} itself and should not pass @samp{-L} options to the
|
|
|
|
linker. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
|
|
|
|
the argument @samp{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search and will
|
|
|
|
pass @samp{-L} options to it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
|
|
|
|
@item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
|
|
|
|
@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
|
|
|
|
the argument @samp{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
|
|
|
|
This macro is similar to @code{LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL}, except that it does
|
|
|
|
not affect @samp{-L} options.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
|
|
|
|
@item LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
|
|
|
|
A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
|
|
|
|
linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
|
|
|
|
change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
|
|
|
|
define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
|
|
|
|
line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
|
|
|
|
the effect you need.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
|
|
|
|
@item MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
|
|
|
|
string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
|
|
|
|
target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
|
|
|
|
the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
|
|
|
|
@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
|
|
|
|
@xref{Target Fragment}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
|
|
|
|
@item RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to tell @code{gcc} that it should only translate
|
|
|
|
a @samp{-B} prefix into a @samp{-L} linker option if the prefix
|
|
|
|
indicates an absolute file name.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
@item STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
|
|
|
|
standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/gcc-lib/} as the default prefix to
|
|
|
|
try when searching for the executable files of the compiler.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MD_EXEC_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
@item MD_EXEC_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
|
|
|
|
@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
|
|
|
|
when the @samp{-b} option is used, or the compiler is built as a cross
|
|
|
|
compiler.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
@item STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
|
|
|
|
standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/} as the default prefix to
|
|
|
|
try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
@item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
|
|
|
|
standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
|
|
|
|
@samp{-b} option is used, or when the compiler is built as a cross
|
|
|
|
compiler.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
|
|
|
|
@item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
|
|
|
|
If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
|
|
|
|
standard prefixes. It is not searched when the @samp{-b} option is
|
|
|
|
used, or when the compiler is built as a cross compiler.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INIT_ENVIRONMENT
|
|
|
|
@item INIT_ENVIRONMENT
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
|
|
|
|
loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
|
|
|
|
initialize the necessary environment variables.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
|
|
|
|
@item LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
|
|
|
|
standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
|
|
|
|
try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
|
|
|
|
comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search either
|
|
|
|
@file{/usr/local/include} or its replacement.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
|
|
|
|
@item SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
|
|
|
|
system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
|
|
|
|
directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
|
|
|
|
@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
|
|
|
|
specified.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
|
|
|
|
@item STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
|
|
|
|
standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
|
|
|
|
try when searching for header files.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search either
|
|
|
|
@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
|
|
|
|
@item STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
|
|
|
|
The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
|
|
|
|
See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
|
|
|
|
If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
|
|
|
|
@item INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
|
|
|
|
usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
|
|
|
|
@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
|
|
|
|
and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
|
|
|
|
and specify private search areas for GCC. The directory
|
|
|
|
@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
|
|
|
|
string constant), the component name, and flag for C++-only directories,
|
|
|
|
and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
|
|
|
|
wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
|
|
|
|
the array with a null element.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
|
|
|
|
if any, in all upper-case letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
|
|
|
|
or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of the a vendor-supplied
|
|
|
|
operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
|
|
|
|
@{ \
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
|
|
|
|
@{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
|
|
|
|
@{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
|
|
|
|
@{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
|
|
|
|
@{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@}
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
Any prefixes specified by the user with @samp{-B}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
@file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
|
|
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
Any prefixes specified by the user with @samp{-B}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
|
|
|
|
(native only, cross compilers do not use this).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
@file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if any.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
@file{/lib/}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
@file{/usr/lib/}.
|
|
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Run-time Target
|
|
|
|
@section Run-time Target Specification
|
|
|
|
@cindex run-time target specification
|
|
|
|
@cindex predefined macros
|
|
|
|
@cindex target specifications
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
Here are run-time target specifications.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex CPP_PREDEFINES
|
|
|
|
@item CPP_PREDEFINES
|
|
|
|
Define this to be a string constant containing @samp{-D} options to
|
|
|
|
define the predefined macros that identify this machine and system.
|
|
|
|
These macros will be predefined unless the @samp{-ansi} option is
|
|
|
|
specified.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In addition, a parallel set of macros are predefined, whose names are
|
|
|
|
made by appending @samp{__} at the beginning and at the end. These
|
|
|
|
@samp{__} macros are permitted by the ANSI standard, so they are
|
|
|
|
predefined regardless of whether @samp{-ansi} is specified.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For example, on the Sun, one can use the following value:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
"-Dmc68000 -Dsun -Dunix"
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The result is to define the macros @code{__mc68000__}, @code{__sun__}
|
|
|
|
and @code{__unix__} unconditionally, and the macros @code{mc68000},
|
|
|
|
@code{sun} and @code{unix} provided @samp{-ansi} is not specified.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex extern int target_flags
|
|
|
|
@item extern int target_flags;
|
|
|
|
This declaration should be present.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex optional hardware or system features
|
|
|
|
@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
|
|
|
|
@item TARGET_@dots{}
|
|
|
|
This series of macros is to allow compiler command arguments to
|
|
|
|
enable or disable the use of optional features of the target machine.
|
|
|
|
For example, one machine description serves both the 68000 and
|
|
|
|
the 68020; a command argument tells the compiler whether it should
|
|
|
|
use 68020-only instructions or not. This command argument works
|
|
|
|
by means of a macro @code{TARGET_68020} that tests a bit in
|
|
|
|
@code{target_flags}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Define a macro @code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} for each such option.
|
|
|
|
Its definition should test a bit in @code{target_flags}; for example:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
#define TARGET_68020 (target_flags & 1)
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
One place where these macros are used is in the condition-expressions
|
|
|
|
of instruction patterns. Note how @code{TARGET_68020} appears
|
|
|
|
frequently in the 68000 machine description file, @file{m68k.md}.
|
|
|
|
Another place they are used is in the definitions of the other
|
|
|
|
macros in the @file{@var{machine}.h} file.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex TARGET_SWITCHES
|
|
|
|
@item TARGET_SWITCHES
|
|
|
|
This macro defines names of command options to set and clear
|
|
|
|
bits in @code{target_flags}. Its definition is an initializer
|
|
|
|
with a subgrouping for each command option.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the option
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
name, a number, which contains the bits to set in
|
|
|
|
@code{target_flags}, and a second string which is the description
|
|
|
|
displayed by --help. If the number is negative then the bits specified
|
|
|
|
by the number are cleared instead of being set. If the description
|
|
|
|
string is present but empty, then no help information will be displayed
|
|
|
|
for that option, but it will not count as an undocumented option. The
|
|
|
|
actual option name is made by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
One of the subgroupings should have a null string. The number in
|
|
|
|
this grouping is the default value for @code{target_flags}. Any
|
|
|
|
target options act starting with that value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Here is an example which defines @samp{-m68000} and @samp{-m68020}
|
|
|
|
with opposite meanings, and picks the latter as the default:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
#define TARGET_SWITCHES \
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@{ @{ "68020", 1, "" @}, \
|
|
|
|
@{ "68000", -1, "Compile for the 68000" @}, \
|
|
|
|
@{ "", 1, "" @}@}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex TARGET_OPTIONS
|
|
|
|
@item TARGET_OPTIONS
|
|
|
|
This macro is similar to @code{TARGET_SWITCHES} but defines names of command
|
|
|
|
options that have values. Its definition is an initializer with a
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
subgrouping for each command option.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the fixed part
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
of the option name, the address of a variable, and a description string.
|
|
|
|
The variable, type @code{char *}, is set to the variable part of the
|
|
|
|
given option if the fixed part matches. The actual option name is made
|
|
|
|
by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Here is an example which defines @samp{-mshort-data-@var{number}}. If the
|
|
|
|
given option is @samp{-mshort-data-512}, the variable @code{m88k_short_data}
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
will be set to the string @code{"512"}.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
extern char *m88k_short_data;
|
|
|
|
#define TARGET_OPTIONS \
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@{ @{ "short-data-", &m88k_short_data, "Specify the size of the short data section" @} @}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex TARGET_VERSION
|
|
|
|
@item TARGET_VERSION
|
|
|
|
This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
|
|
|
|
describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
|
|
|
|
description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
#ifdef MOTOROLA
|
|
|
|
#define TARGET_VERSION \
|
|
|
|
fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
#define TARGET_VERSION \
|
|
|
|
fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
|
|
|
|
@item OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
|
|
|
|
Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
|
|
|
|
a particular target machine. You can define a macro
|
|
|
|
@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS} to take account of this. This macro, if
|
|
|
|
defined, is executed once just after all the command options have been
|
|
|
|
parsed.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Don't use this macro to turn on various extra optimizations for
|
|
|
|
@samp{-O}. That is what @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} is for.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@item OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS (@var{level}, @var{size})
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
|
|
|
|
various optimization levels. This macro, if defined, is executed once
|
|
|
|
just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
|
|
|
|
of the command options have been parsed. Values set in this macro are
|
|
|
|
used as the default values for the other command line options.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@var{level} is the optimization level specified; 2 if @samp{-O2} is
|
|
|
|
specified, 1 if @samp{-O} is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@var{size} is non-zero if @samp{-Os} is specified and zero otherwise.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
You should not use this macro to change options that are not
|
|
|
|
machine-specific. These should uniformly selected by the same
|
|
|
|
optimization level on all supported machines. Use this macro to enable
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
machine-specific optimizations.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@strong{Do not examine @code{write_symbols} in
|
|
|
|
this macro!} The debugging options are not supposed to alter the
|
|
|
|
generated code.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
|
|
|
|
@item CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if debugging can be performed even without a frame
|
|
|
|
pointer. If this macro is defined, GNU CC will turn on the
|
|
|
|
@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer} option whenever @samp{-O} is specified.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Storage Layout
|
|
|
|
@section Storage Layout
|
|
|
|
@cindex storage layout
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
|
|
|
|
alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
|
|
|
|
expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
|
|
|
|
@xref{Run-time Target}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
|
|
|
|
@item BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
|
|
|
|
byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
|
|
|
|
This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
|
|
|
|
bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
|
|
|
|
be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
|
|
|
|
macro need not be a constant.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
|
|
|
|
bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
|
|
|
|
@item BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
|
|
|
|
word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
|
|
|
|
@item WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
|
|
|
|
most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
|
|
|
|
memory locations and registers; GNU CC fundamentally assumes that the
|
|
|
|
order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
|
|
|
|
macro need not be a constant.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
|
|
|
|
@item LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN is not constant. This must be a
|
|
|
|
constant value with the same meaning as WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN, which will be
|
|
|
|
used only when compiling libgcc2.c. Typically the value will be set
|
|
|
|
based on preprocessor defines.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
|
|
|
|
@item FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
|
|
|
|
@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
|
|
|
|
containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
|
|
|
|
have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
|
|
|
|
multi-word integers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex BITS_PER_UNIT
|
|
|
|
@item BITS_PER_UNIT
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
|
|
|
|
unit (byte); normally 8.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex BITS_PER_WORD
|
|
|
|
@item BITS_PER_WORD
|
|
|
|
Number of bits in a word; normally 32.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
|
|
|
|
@item MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
|
|
|
|
Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
|
|
|
|
@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
|
|
|
|
largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex UNITS_PER_WORD
|
|
|
|
@item UNITS_PER_WORD
|
|
|
|
Number of storage units in a word; normally 4.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
|
|
|
|
@item MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
|
|
|
|
Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
|
|
|
|
@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
|
|
|
|
smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex POINTER_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item POINTER_SIZE
|
|
|
|
Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
|
|
|
|
width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
|
|
|
|
you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
|
|
|
|
@item POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
A C expression whose value is nonzero if pointers that need to be
|
|
|
|
extended from being @code{POINTER_SIZE} bits wide to @code{Pmode} are to
|
|
|
|
be zero-extended and zero if they are to be sign-extended.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if the @code{POINTER_SIZE} is equal
|
|
|
|
to the width of @code{Pmode}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PROMOTE_MODE
|
|
|
|
@item PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
|
|
|
|
A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
|
|
|
|
is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
|
|
|
|
stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
|
|
|
|
scalar type.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
|
|
|
|
register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
|
|
|
|
@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
|
|
|
|
cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
|
|
|
|
floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
|
|
|
|
counterparts.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
|
|
|
|
However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
|
|
|
|
either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
|
|
|
|
the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
|
|
|
|
sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
|
|
|
|
@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
|
|
|
|
@item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
should also be done for outgoing function arguments.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
|
|
|
|
@item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
|
|
|
|
should also be done for the return value of functions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is defined, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same
|
|
|
|
promotions done by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
|
|
|
|
@item PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
|
|
|
|
should @emph{only} be performed for outgoing function arguments or
|
|
|
|
function return values, as specified by @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS}
|
|
|
|
and @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN}, respectively.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PARM_BOUNDARY
|
|
|
|
@item PARM_BOUNDARY
|
|
|
|
Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
|
|
|
|
bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
|
|
|
|
regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
|
|
|
|
size of an integer.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_BOUNDARY
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_BOUNDARY
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for
|
|
|
|
the stack pointer. The definition is a C expression
|
|
|
|
for the desired alignment (measured in bits).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{PUSH_ROUNDING}, interaction with @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}
|
|
|
|
If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is not defined, the stack will always be aligned
|
|
|
|
to the specified boundary. If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is defined and specifies a
|
|
|
|
less strict alignment than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, the stack may be
|
|
|
|
momentarily unaligned while pushing arguments.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
|
|
|
|
Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
@item BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in bits.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
@item MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
|
|
|
|
object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
|
|
|
|
nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
|
|
|
|
on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
@item BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
Biggest alignment that any structure field can require on this machine,
|
|
|
|
in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
|
|
|
|
structure fields only.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN
|
|
|
|
@item ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
|
|
|
|
An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
|
|
|
|
alignment computed in the usual way is @var{computed}. GNU CC uses
|
|
|
|
this value instead of the value in @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} or
|
|
|
|
@code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT}, if defined, for structure fields only.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
@item MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
|
|
|
|
Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
|
|
|
|
@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
|
|
|
|
the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DATA_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
@item DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variables in
|
|
|
|
the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
|
|
|
|
the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex strcpy
|
|
|
|
One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
|
|
|
|
make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
|
|
|
|
arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
|
|
|
|
constants to character arrays can be done inline.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
@item CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
|
|
|
|
that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
|
|
|
|
@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
|
|
|
|
have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
|
|
|
|
align the object.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
|
|
|
|
constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
|
|
|
|
constants can be done inline.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
|
|
|
|
@item EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
|
|
|
|
Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit field that follows an
|
|
|
|
empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} also affects the alignment
|
|
|
|
that results from an empty field.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
|
|
|
|
@item STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
|
|
|
|
Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
|
|
|
|
Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
|
|
|
|
@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STRICT_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
@item STRICT_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
|
|
|
|
if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
|
|
|
|
go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
|
|
|
|
@item PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
|
|
|
|
Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
|
|
|
|
alignment of bitfields and the structures that contain them.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The behavior is that the type written for a bitfield (@code{int},
|
|
|
|
@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the
|
|
|
|
entire structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary
|
|
|
|
field of that type. In addition, the bitfield is placed within the
|
|
|
|
structure so that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a
|
|
|
|
boundary for it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Thus, on most machines, a bitfield whose type is written as @code{int}
|
|
|
|
would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force four-byte
|
|
|
|
alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may not be four
|
|
|
|
bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
|
|
|
|
a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
|
|
|
|
bitfields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
|
|
|
|
support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
|
|
|
|
@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The other known way of making bitfields work is to define
|
|
|
|
@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
|
|
|
|
Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Unless the machine has bitfield instructions or you define
|
|
|
|
@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
|
|
|
|
@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If your aim is to make GNU CC use the same conventions for laying out
|
|
|
|
bitfields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
|
|
|
|
what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
struct foo1
|
|
|
|
@{
|
|
|
|
char x;
|
|
|
|
char :0;
|
|
|
|
char y;
|
|
|
|
@};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
struct foo2
|
|
|
|
@{
|
|
|
|
char x;
|
|
|
|
int :0;
|
|
|
|
char y;
|
|
|
|
@};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
main ()
|
|
|
|
@{
|
|
|
|
printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
|
|
|
|
sizeof (struct foo1));
|
|
|
|
printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
|
|
|
|
sizeof (struct foo2));
|
|
|
|
exit (0);
|
|
|
|
@}
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
|
|
|
|
get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
|
|
|
|
@item BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
|
|
|
|
Like PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS except that its effect is limited to
|
|
|
|
aligning a bitfield within the structure.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE (@var{struct}, @var{size}, @var{align})
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Define this macro as an expression for the overall size of a structure
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
(given by @var{struct} as a tree node) when the size computed from the
|
|
|
|
fields is @var{size} and the alignment is @var{align}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default is to round @var{size} up to a multiple of @var{align}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN
|
|
|
|
@item ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{struct}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a structure
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
(given by @var{struct} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the
|
|
|
|
usual way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
|
|
|
|
@var{specified}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
|
|
|
|
the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
|
|
|
|
machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
|
|
|
|
this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
|
|
|
|
appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
|
|
|
|
(DImode)} is assumed.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
|
|
|
|
If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
|
|
|
|
specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
|
|
|
|
@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
|
|
|
|
@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
|
|
|
|
@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
|
|
|
|
having its mode specified.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
|
|
|
|
would most commonly define this macro if the
|
|
|
|
@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
|
|
|
|
64-bit mode.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_SIZE_MODE
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_SIZE_MODE
|
|
|
|
If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
|
|
|
|
specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
|
|
|
|
@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
|
|
|
|
You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
|
|
|
|
pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex CHECK_FLOAT_VALUE
|
|
|
|
@item CHECK_FLOAT_VALUE (@var{mode}, @var{value}, @var{overflow})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to validate the value @var{value} (of type
|
|
|
|
@code{double}) for mode @var{mode}. This means that you check whether
|
|
|
|
@var{value} fits within the possible range of values for mode
|
|
|
|
@var{mode} on this target machine. The mode @var{mode} is always
|
|
|
|
a mode of class @code{MODE_FLOAT}. @var{overflow} is nonzero if
|
|
|
|
the value is already known to be out of range.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If @var{value} is not valid or if @var{overflow} is nonzero, you should
|
|
|
|
set @var{overflow} to 1 and then assign some valid value to @var{value}.
|
|
|
|
Allowing an invalid value to go through the compiler can produce
|
|
|
|
incorrect assembler code which may even cause Unix assemblers to crash.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not be defined if there is no work for it to do.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
|
|
|
@item TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
|
|
|
A code distinguishing the floating point format of the target machine.
|
|
|
|
There are three defined values:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
|
|
|
@item IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
|
|
|
This code indicates IEEE floating point. It is the default; there is no
|
|
|
|
need to define this macro when the format is IEEE.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
|
|
|
@item VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
|
|
|
This code indicates the peculiar format used on the Vax.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
|
|
|
@item UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
|
|
|
|
This code indicates any other format.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The value of this macro is compared with @code{HOST_FLOAT_FORMAT}
|
|
|
|
(@pxref{Config}) to determine whether the target machine has the same
|
|
|
|
format as the host machine. If any other formats are actually in use on
|
|
|
|
supported machines, new codes should be defined for them.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The ordering of the component words of floating point values stored in
|
|
|
|
memory is controlled by @code{FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} for the target
|
|
|
|
machine and @code{HOST_FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} for the host.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DEFAULT_VTABLE_THUNKS
|
|
|
|
@item DEFAULT_VTABLE_THUNKS
|
|
|
|
GNU CC supports two ways of implementing C++ vtables: traditional or with
|
|
|
|
so-called ``thunks''. The flag @samp{-fvtable-thunk} chooses between them.
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to be a C expression for the default value of that flag.
|
|
|
|
If @code{DEFAULT_VTABLE_THUNKS} is 0, GNU CC uses the traditional
|
|
|
|
implementation by default. The ``thunk'' implementation is more efficient
|
|
|
|
(especially if you have provided an implementation of
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK}, see @ref{Function Entry}), but is not binary
|
|
|
|
compatible with code compiled using the traditional implementation.
|
|
|
|
If you are writing a new ports, define @code{DEFAULT_VTABLE_THUNKS} to 1.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you do not define this macro, the default for @samp{-fvtable-thunk} is 0.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Type Layout
|
|
|
|
@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
|
|
|
|
basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
|
|
|
|
the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
|
|
|
|
languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex INT_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item INT_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
|
|
|
|
target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MAX_INT_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item MAX_INT_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the target
|
|
|
|
machine. If this is undefined, the default is @code{INT_TYPE_SIZE}.
|
|
|
|
Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the largest value that
|
|
|
|
@code{INT_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time. This is used in @code{cpp}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
|
|
|
|
target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
|
|
|
|
(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
|
|
|
|
unit.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LONG_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item LONG_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
|
|
|
|
target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
|
|
|
|
target machine. If this is undefined, the default is
|
|
|
|
@code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
|
|
|
|
largest value that @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time. This is
|
|
|
|
used in @code{cpp}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
|
|
|
|
target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
|
|
|
|
words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of
|
|
|
|
macro must be at least 64.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
|
|
|
|
target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one quarter
|
|
|
|
of a word. (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up
|
|
|
|
to one unit.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MAX_CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item MAX_CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
|
|
|
|
target machine. If this is undefined, the default is
|
|
|
|
@code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
|
|
|
|
largest value that @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time. This is
|
|
|
|
used in @code{cpp}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
|
|
|
|
target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
|
|
|
|
target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
|
|
|
|
words.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
|
|
|
|
the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
|
|
|
|
words.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
|
|
|
|
supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
|
|
|
|
value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
|
|
|
|
If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
|
|
|
|
is the default.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
|
|
|
|
@item DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
|
|
|
|
An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
|
|
|
|
@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
|
|
|
|
always override this default with the options @samp{-fsigned-char}
|
|
|
|
and @samp{-funsigned-char}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
|
|
|
|
@item DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
A C expression to determine whether to give an @code{enum} type
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range of possible values
|
|
|
|
of that type. A nonzero value means to do that; a zero value means all
|
|
|
|
@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define the macro, the default is 0.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SIZE_TYPE
|
|
|
|
@item SIZE_TYPE
|
|
|
|
A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
|
|
|
|
for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
|
|
|
|
contents of the string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
|
|
|
|
spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
|
|
|
|
appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
|
|
|
|
of the data type names defined in the function
|
|
|
|
@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
|
|
|
|
omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
|
|
|
|
crash on startup.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
|
|
|
|
int"}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PTRDIFF_TYPE
|
|
|
|
@item PTRDIFF_TYPE
|
|
|
|
A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
|
|
|
|
for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
|
|
|
|
@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
|
|
|
|
@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex WCHAR_TYPE
|
|
|
|
@item WCHAR_TYPE
|
|
|
|
A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
|
|
|
|
for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
|
|
|
|
the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
|
|
|
|
information.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
|
|
|
|
characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
|
|
|
|
@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
Maximum number for the size in bits of the data type for wide
|
|
|
|
characters. If this is undefined, the default is
|
|
|
|
@code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
|
|
|
|
largest value that @code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time. This is
|
|
|
|
used in @code{cpp}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex OBJC_INT_SELECTORS
|
|
|
|
@item OBJC_INT_SELECTORS
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the type of Objective C selectors should be
|
|
|
|
@code{int}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, then selectors should have the type
|
|
|
|
@code{struct objc_selector *}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex OBJC_SELECTORS_WITHOUT_LABELS
|
|
|
|
@item OBJC_SELECTORS_WITHOUT_LABELS
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the compiler can group all the selectors together
|
|
|
|
into a vector and use just one label at the beginning of the vector.
|
|
|
|
Otherwise, the compiler must give each selector its own assembler
|
|
|
|
label.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On certain machines, it is important to have a separate label for each
|
|
|
|
selector because this enables the linker to eliminate duplicate selectors.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex TARGET_BELL
|
|
|
|
@item TARGET_BELL
|
|
|
|
A C constant expression for the integer value for escape sequence
|
|
|
|
@samp{\a}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex TARGET_TAB
|
|
|
|
@findex TARGET_BS
|
|
|
|
@findex TARGET_NEWLINE
|
|
|
|
@item TARGET_BS
|
|
|
|
@itemx TARGET_TAB
|
|
|
|
@itemx TARGET_NEWLINE
|
|
|
|
C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
|
|
|
|
@samp{\b}, @samp{\t} and @samp{\n}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex TARGET_VT
|
|
|
|
@findex TARGET_FF
|
|
|
|
@findex TARGET_CR
|
|
|
|
@item TARGET_VT
|
|
|
|
@itemx TARGET_FF
|
|
|
|
@itemx TARGET_CR
|
|
|
|
C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
|
|
|
|
@samp{\v}, @samp{\f} and @samp{\r}.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Registers
|
|
|
|
@section Register Usage
|
|
|
|
@cindex register usage
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
|
|
|
|
has, and how (in general) they can be used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
|
|
|
|
done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
|
|
|
|
on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
|
|
|
|
For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
|
|
|
|
For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
|
|
* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
|
|
|
|
* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
|
|
|
|
* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
|
|
|
|
* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
|
|
|
|
* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
|
|
|
|
* Obsolete Register Macros:: Macros formerly used for the 80387.
|
|
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Register Basics
|
|
|
|
@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
Registers have various characteristics.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
|
|
|
@item FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
|
|
|
Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
|
|
|
|
numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
|
|
|
|
pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
|
|
|
|
@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item FIXED_REGISTERS
|
|
|
|
@findex FIXED_REGISTERS
|
|
|
|
@cindex fixed register
|
|
|
|
An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
|
|
|
|
all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
|
|
|
|
general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
|
|
|
|
pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
|
|
|
|
register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
|
|
|
|
machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
|
|
|
|
and any other numbered register with a standard use.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
|
|
|
|
commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
|
|
|
|
register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
|
|
|
|
the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
|
|
|
|
by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
|
|
|
|
the user with the command options @samp{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
|
|
|
|
@samp{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @samp{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CALL_USED_REGISTERS
|
|
|
|
@item CALL_USED_REGISTERS
|
|
|
|
@cindex call-used register
|
|
|
|
@cindex call-clobbered register
|
|
|
|
@cindex call-saved register
|
|
|
|
Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
|
|
|
|
clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
|
|
|
|
registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
|
|
|
|
available for general allocation of values that must live across
|
|
|
|
function calls.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
|
|
|
|
automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
|
|
|
|
exit, if the register is used within the function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
|
|
|
|
@findex fixed_regs
|
|
|
|
@findex call_used_regs
|
|
|
|
@item CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
|
|
|
|
Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify two variables
|
|
|
|
@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} (both of type @code{char
|
|
|
|
[]}) after they have been initialized from the two preceding macros.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This is necessary in case the fixed or call-clobbered registers depend
|
|
|
|
on target flags.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex disabling certain registers
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@cindex controlling register usage
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
|
|
|
|
flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
|
|
|
|
@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
|
|
|
|
registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC. Also define
|
|
|
|
the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
|
|
|
|
is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
|
|
|
|
of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
|
|
|
|
controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
|
|
|
|
these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex NON_SAVING_SETJMP
|
|
|
|
@item NON_SAVING_SETJMP
|
|
|
|
If this macro is defined and has a nonzero value, it means that
|
|
|
|
@code{setjmp} and related functions fail to save the registers, or that
|
|
|
|
@code{longjmp} fails to restore them. To compensate, the compiler
|
|
|
|
avoids putting variables in registers in functions that use
|
|
|
|
@code{setjmp}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INCOMING_REGNO
|
|
|
|
@item INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
|
|
|
|
expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
|
|
|
|
corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
|
|
|
|
function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
|
|
|
|
outbound register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex OUTGOING_REGNO
|
|
|
|
@item OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
|
|
|
|
expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
|
|
|
|
corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
|
|
|
|
function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
|
|
|
|
register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@ignore
|
|
|
|
@findex PC_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
@item PC_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
|
|
|
|
register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
|
|
|
|
@end ignore
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Allocation Order
|
|
|
|
@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
|
|
|
|
@cindex order of register allocation
|
|
|
|
@cindex register allocation order
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
Registers are allocated in order.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex REG_ALLOC_ORDER
|
|
|
|
@item REG_ALLOC_ORDER
|
|
|
|
If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
|
|
|
|
numbers of hard registers in the order in which GNU CC should prefer
|
|
|
|
to use them (from most preferred to least).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
|
|
|
|
(all else being equal).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
|
|
|
|
registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
|
|
|
|
instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
|
|
|
|
machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
the highest numbered allocable register first.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
|
|
|
|
@item ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
|
|
|
|
hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
|
|
|
|
Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
|
|
|
|
register; and so on.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
|
|
|
|
@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Values in Registers
|
|
|
|
@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
|
|
|
|
(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
|
|
|
|
consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex HARD_REGNO_NREGS
|
|
|
|
@item HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
|
|
|
|
at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
|
|
|
|
@var{mode}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
|
|
|
|
definition of this macro is
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
|
|
|
|
((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
|
|
|
|
/ UNITS_PER_WORD))
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex ALTER_HARD_SUBREG
|
|
|
|
@item ALTER_HARD_SUBREG (@var{tgt_mode}, @var{word}, @var{src_mode}, @var{regno})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that returns an adjusted hard register number for
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
(subreg:@var{tgt_mode} (reg:@var{src_mode} @var{regno}) @var{word})
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This may be needed if the target machine has mixed sized big-endian
|
|
|
|
registers, like Sparc v9.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
|
|
|
|
@item HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
|
|
|
|
of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
|
|
|
|
registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
|
|
|
|
are equivalent, a suitable definition is
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
|
|
|
|
because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex register pairs
|
|
|
|
On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
|
|
|
|
odd register numbers for such modes.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
|
|
|
|
@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
|
|
|
|
value into the register and back out not alter it.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
|
|
|
|
all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
|
|
|
|
you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
|
|
|
|
is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
|
|
|
|
and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
|
|
|
|
to be tieable.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
|
|
|
|
Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
|
|
|
|
in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
|
|
|
|
can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
|
|
|
|
mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
|
|
|
|
registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
|
|
|
|
modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
|
|
|
|
registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
|
|
|
|
non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
|
|
|
|
@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
|
|
|
|
floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
|
|
|
|
normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
|
|
|
|
unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
|
|
|
|
register, so you can define this macro to say so.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
|
|
|
|
they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
|
|
|
|
instructions. However, this is of no concern to
|
|
|
|
@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
|
|
|
|
constraints for those instructions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
|
|
|
|
so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
|
|
|
|
register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
|
|
|
|
floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
|
|
|
|
be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MODES_TIEABLE_P
|
|
|
|
@item MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
|
|
|
|
@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
|
|
|
|
any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
|
|
|
|
should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
|
|
|
|
this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
|
|
|
|
accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
|
|
|
|
possible since doing so will allow GNU CC to perform better register
|
|
|
|
allocation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
|
|
|
|
@item AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
|
|
|
|
registers. You should only define this macro if support fo copying to/from
|
|
|
|
@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Leaf Functions
|
|
|
|
@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex leaf functions
|
|
|
|
@cindex functions, leaf
|
|
|
|
On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
|
|
|
|
more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
|
|
|
|
means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
|
|
|
|
are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
|
|
|
|
normally arrive.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
|
|
|
|
other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
|
|
|
|
registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
|
|
|
|
function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
|
|
|
|
handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
|
|
|
|
functions''.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
GNU CC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
|
|
|
|
suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
|
|
|
|
registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
|
|
|
|
accomplish this.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex LEAF_REGISTERS
|
|
|
|
@item LEAF_REGISTERS
|
|
|
|
A C initializer for a vector, indexed by hard register number, which
|
|
|
|
contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
|
|
|
|
function treatment.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
|
|
|
|
registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
|
|
|
|
GNU CC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
|
|
|
|
used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
|
|
|
|
in this vector.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
|
|
|
|
the treatment of leaf functions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LEAF_REG_REMAP
|
|
|
|
@item LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
|
|
|
|
A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
|
|
|
|
should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
|
|
|
|
function before renumbering, then the expression should yield -1, which
|
|
|
|
will cause the compiler to abort.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
|
|
|
|
treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
|
|
|
|
this.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex leaf_function
|
|
|
|
Normally, @code{FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and @code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must
|
|
|
|
treat leaf functions specially. It can test the C variable
|
|
|
|
@code{leaf_function} which is nonzero for leaf functions. (The variable
|
|
|
|
@code{leaf_function} is defined only if @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is
|
|
|
|
defined.)
|
|
|
|
@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Stack Registers
|
|
|
|
@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
There are special features to handle computers where some of the
|
|
|
|
``registers'' form a stack, as in the 80387 coprocessor for the 80386.
|
|
|
|
Stack registers are normally written by pushing onto the stack, and are
|
|
|
|
numbered relative to the top of the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Currently, GNU CC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
|
|
|
|
they must be consecutively numbered.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_REGS
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_REGS
|
|
|
|
Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FIRST_STACK_REG
|
|
|
|
@item FIRST_STACK_REG
|
|
|
|
The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
|
|
|
|
of the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LAST_STACK_REG
|
|
|
|
@item LAST_STACK_REG
|
|
|
|
The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
|
|
|
|
the stack.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Obsolete Register Macros
|
|
|
|
@subsection Obsolete Macros for Controlling Register Usage
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
These features do not work very well. They exist because they used to
|
|
|
|
be required to generate correct code for the 80387 coprocessor of the
|
|
|
|
80386. They are no longer used by that machine description and may be
|
|
|
|
removed in a later version of the compiler. Don't use them!
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex OVERLAPPING_REGNO_P
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@item OVERLAPPING_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
|
|
|
|
If defined, this is a C expression whose value is nonzero if hard
|
|
|
|
register number @var{regno} is an overlapping register. This means a
|
|
|
|
hard register which overlaps a hard register with a different number.
|
|
|
|
(Such overlap is undesirable, but occasionally it allows a machine to
|
|
|
|
be supported which otherwise could not be.) This macro must return
|
|
|
|
nonzero for @emph{all} the registers which overlap each other. GNU CC
|
|
|
|
can use an overlapping register only in certain limited ways. It can
|
|
|
|
be used for allocation within a basic block, and may be spilled for
|
|
|
|
reloading; that is all.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, it means that none of the hard registers
|
|
|
|
overlap each other. This is the usual situation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INSN_CLOBBERS_REGNO_P
|
|
|
|
@item INSN_CLOBBERS_REGNO_P (@var{insn}, @var{regno})
|
|
|
|
If defined, this is a C expression whose value should be nonzero if
|
|
|
|
the insn @var{insn} has the effect of mysteriously clobbering the
|
|
|
|
contents of hard register number @var{regno}. By ``mysterious'' we
|
|
|
|
mean that the insn's RTL expression doesn't describe such an effect.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, it means that no insn clobbers registers
|
|
|
|
mysteriously. This is the usual situation; all else being equal,
|
|
|
|
it is best for the RTL expression to show all the activity.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex death notes
|
|
|
|
@findex PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P
|
|
|
|
@item PRESERVE_DEATH_INFO_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
If defined, this is a C expression whose value is nonzero if correct
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{REG_DEAD} notes are needed for hard register number @var{regno}
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
after reload.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You would arrange to preserve death info for a register when some of the
|
|
|
|
code in the machine description which is executed to write the assembler
|
|
|
|
code looks at the death notes. This is necessary only when the actual
|
|
|
|
hardware feature which GNU CC thinks of as a register is not actually a
|
|
|
|
register of the usual sort. (It might, for example, be a hardware
|
|
|
|
stack.)
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
It is also useful for peepholes and linker relaxation.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, it means that no death notes need to be
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
preserved, and some may even be incorrect. This is the usual situation.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Register Classes
|
|
|
|
@section Register Classes
|
|
|
|
@cindex register class definitions
|
|
|
|
@cindex class definitions, register
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
|
|
|
|
For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
|
|
|
|
certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
|
|
|
|
restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
|
|
|
|
which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
|
|
|
|
that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ALL_REGS
|
|
|
|
@findex NO_REGS
|
|
|
|
In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
|
|
|
|
class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
|
|
|
|
class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
|
|
|
|
union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex GENERAL_REGS
|
|
|
|
One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
|
|
|
|
terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
|
|
|
|
@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
|
|
|
|
the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
|
|
|
|
to @code{ALL_REGS}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
|
|
|
|
then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
|
|
|
|
constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
|
|
|
|
You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
|
|
|
|
them in operand constraints.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
|
|
|
|
instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
|
|
|
|
either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
|
|
|
|
certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
|
|
|
|
which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
|
|
|
|
classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
|
|
|
|
contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
|
|
|
|
in their union.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
|
|
|
|
certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
|
|
|
|
Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
|
|
|
|
a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
|
|
|
|
specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
|
|
|
|
instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
|
|
|
|
each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
|
|
|
|
mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
|
|
|
|
single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
|
|
|
|
this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
|
|
|
|
instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
|
|
|
|
single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
|
|
|
|
@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex enum reg_class
|
|
|
|
@item enum reg_class
|
|
|
|
An enumeral type that must be defined with all the register class names
|
|
|
|
as enumeral values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
|
|
|
|
must be the last register class, followed by one more enumeral value,
|
|
|
|
@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
|
|
|
|
tells how many classes there are.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
|
|
|
|
the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
|
|
|
|
in many of the tables described below.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex N_REG_CLASSES
|
|
|
|
@item N_REG_CLASSES
|
|
|
|
The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REG_CLASS_NAMES
|
|
|
|
@item REG_CLASS_NAMES
|
|
|
|
An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
|
|
|
|
constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
|
|
|
|
@item REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
|
|
|
|
An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
|
|
|
|
which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
|
|
|
|
@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
|
|
|
|
register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
|
|
|
|
Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
|
|
|
|
several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
|
|
|
|
for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex REGNO_REG_CLASS
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@item REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
|
|
|
|
A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
|
|
|
|
@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
|
|
|
|
which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
|
|
|
|
register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex BASE_REG_CLASS
|
|
|
|
@item BASE_REG_CLASS
|
|
|
|
A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
|
|
|
|
base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
|
|
|
|
which is the register value plus a displacement.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INDEX_REG_CLASS
|
|
|
|
@item INDEX_REG_CLASS
|
|
|
|
A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
|
|
|
|
index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
|
|
|
|
address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
|
|
|
|
added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER
|
|
|
|
@item REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
|
|
|
|
A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
|
|
|
|
letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
|
|
|
|
value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
|
|
|
|
the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
|
|
|
|
corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
|
|
|
|
to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P
|
|
|
|
@item REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
|
|
|
|
A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
|
|
|
|
suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses. It may be
|
|
|
|
either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
|
|
|
|
allocated such a hard register.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
|
|
|
|
@item REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
|
|
|
|
that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
|
|
|
|
@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
|
|
|
|
reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
|
|
|
|
you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
|
|
|
|
@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
|
|
|
|
@item REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
|
|
|
|
A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
|
|
|
|
suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
|
|
|
|
either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
|
|
|
|
allocated such a hard register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The difference between an index register and a base register is that
|
|
|
|
the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
|
|
|
|
two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
|
|
|
|
labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
|
|
|
|
labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
|
|
|
|
may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
|
|
|
|
looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
|
|
|
|
only if neither labeling works.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
|
|
|
|
@item PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
|
|
|
|
to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
|
|
|
|
@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
|
|
|
|
another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
safe:
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
|
|
|
|
example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
|
|
|
|
for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
|
|
|
|
@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
|
|
|
|
Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If @var{x} is a @code{const_double}, by returning @code{NO_REGS}
|
|
|
|
you can force @var{x} into a memory constant. This is useful on
|
|
|
|
certain machines where immediate floating values cannot be loaded into
|
|
|
|
certain kinds of registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
|
|
|
|
@item PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
|
|
|
|
Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
|
|
|
|
input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
|
|
|
|
@var{class}, unchanged.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS
|
|
|
|
@item LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
|
|
|
|
to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
|
|
|
|
@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
|
|
|
|
ordinarily be used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
|
|
|
|
there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
|
|
|
|
smaller class.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
|
|
|
|
require the macro to do something nontrivial.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS
|
|
|
|
@findex SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
|
|
|
|
@findex SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
|
|
|
|
@item SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
|
|
|
|
@itemx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
|
|
|
|
@itemx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
|
|
|
|
Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
|
|
|
|
from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
|
|
|
|
@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
|
|
|
|
from general registers, but not memory. Some machines allow copying all
|
|
|
|
registers to and from memory, but require a scratch register for stores
|
|
|
|
to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic address on the RT,
|
|
|
|
and those with certain symbolic address on the Sparc when compiling
|
|
|
|
PIC). In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are
|
|
|
|
required.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You should define these macros to indicate to the reload phase that it may
|
|
|
|
need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
|
|
|
|
register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
|
|
|
|
register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
|
|
|
|
you should define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
|
|
|
|
largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
|
|
|
|
intermediate registers or scratch registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
|
|
|
|
intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
|
|
|
|
should be defined to return the largest register class required. If the
|
|
|
|
requirements for input and output reloads are the same, the macro
|
|
|
|
@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should be used instead of defining both
|
|
|
|
macros identically.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
|
|
|
|
Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
|
|
|
|
can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
|
|
|
|
@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
|
|
|
|
macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
|
|
|
|
intermediate register), you should define patterns for
|
|
|
|
@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
|
|
|
|
(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which will normally be
|
|
|
|
implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
|
|
|
|
@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
register.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Define constraints for the reload register and scratch register that
|
|
|
|
contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
|
|
|
|
class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
|
|
|
|
value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
|
|
|
|
register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
|
|
|
|
Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
|
|
|
|
pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
|
|
|
|
Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return -1 if the pseudo is
|
|
|
|
in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
|
|
|
|
registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
|
|
|
|
registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
|
|
|
|
would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
|
|
|
|
the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as a
|
|
|
|
intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
|
|
|
|
general registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
|
|
|
|
@item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
|
|
|
|
Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
|
|
|
|
to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
|
|
|
|
those machines to be a C expression that is non-zero if objects of mode
|
|
|
|
@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
|
|
|
|
class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
|
|
|
|
and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX
|
|
|
|
@item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
|
|
|
|
Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
|
|
|
|
allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
|
|
|
|
If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
|
|
|
|
defined by this macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if you do not define
|
|
|
|
@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE
|
|
|
|
@item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
|
|
|
|
When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
|
|
|
|
registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
|
|
|
|
hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
|
|
|
|
load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
|
|
|
|
same as that of @var{mode}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
|
|
|
|
bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
|
|
|
|
in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
|
|
|
|
registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
|
|
|
|
the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
|
|
|
|
differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
|
|
|
|
widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
|
|
|
|
suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
|
|
|
|
details.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if you do not define
|
|
|
|
@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
|
|
|
|
is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
|
|
|
|
@item SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
|
|
|
|
Normally the compiler avoids choosing registers that have been
|
|
|
|
explicitly mentioned in the rtl as spill registers (these registers are
|
|
|
|
normally those used to pass parameters and return values). However,
|
|
|
|
some machines have so few registers of certain classes that there
|
|
|
|
would not be enough registers to use as spill registers if this were
|
|
|
|
done.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Define @code{SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES} to be an expression with a non-zero
|
|
|
|
value on these machines. When this macro has a non-zero value, the
|
|
|
|
compiler allows registers explicitly used in the rtl to be used as spill
|
|
|
|
registers but avoids extending the lifetime of these registers.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
It is always safe to define this macro with a non-zero value, but if you
|
|
|
|
unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
|
|
|
|
that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this macro
|
|
|
|
with a non-zero value when it is required, the compiler will run out of
|
|
|
|
spill registers and print a fatal error message. For most machines, you
|
|
|
|
should not define this macro at all.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
|
|
|
|
@item CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (@var{class})
|
|
|
|
A C expression whose value is nonzero if pseudos that have been assigned
|
|
|
|
to registers of class @var{class} would likely be spilled because
|
|
|
|
registers of @var{class} are needed for spill registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default value of this macro returns 1 if @var{class} has exactly one
|
|
|
|
register and zero otherwise. On most machines, this default should be
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
used. Only define this macro to some other expression if pseudos
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their hard
|
|
|
|
registers were needed for spill registers. If this macro returns nonzero
|
|
|
|
for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
|
|
|
|
@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
|
|
|
|
register. If there would not be another register available for
|
|
|
|
reallocation, you should not change the definition of this macro since
|
|
|
|
the only effect of such a definition would be to slow down register
|
|
|
|
allocation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CLASS_MAX_NREGS
|
|
|
|
@item CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
|
|
|
|
of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
|
|
|
|
the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
|
|
|
|
should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
|
|
|
|
@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
|
|
|
|
in the reload pass.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression for a class that contains registers which the
|
|
|
|
compiler must always access in a mode that is the same size as the mode
|
|
|
|
in which it loaded the register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
|
|
|
|
floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64-bits.
|
|
|
|
Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
|
|
|
|
does not store the low-order 32-bits, as would be the case for a normal
|
|
|
|
register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines this macro as
|
|
|
|
@code{FLOAT_REGS}.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Three other special macros describe which operands fit which constraint
|
|
|
|
letters.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
|
|
|
|
@item CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
|
|
|
|
letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
|
|
|
|
particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
|
|
|
|
letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
|
|
|
|
the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
|
|
|
|
not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
|
|
|
|
@var{value}.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
|
|
|
|
@item CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
|
|
|
|
(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
|
|
|
|
@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
|
|
|
|
range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
|
|
|
|
letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
|
|
|
|
@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
|
|
|
|
or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
|
|
|
|
between these kinds.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex EXTRA_CONSTRAINT
|
|
|
|
@item EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
letters (@samp{Q}, @samp{R}, @samp{S}, @samp{T}, @samp{U}) that can
|
|
|
|
be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually memory
|
|
|
|
references, for the target machine. Normally this macro will not be
|
|
|
|
defined. If it is required for a particular target machine, it should
|
|
|
|
return 1 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by
|
|
|
|
the constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
|
|
|
|
constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output in r0 if
|
|
|
|
the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint letter
|
|
|
|
@samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
|
|
|
|
@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
|
|
|
|
a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
|
|
|
|
alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
|
|
|
|
does not include r0 on the output.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Stack and Calling
|
|
|
|
@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
|
|
|
|
@cindex calling conventions
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
|
|
* Frame Layout::
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
* Stack Checking::
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
* Frame Registers::
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
* Elimination::
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
* Stack Arguments::
|
|
|
|
* Register Arguments::
|
|
|
|
* Scalar Return::
|
|
|
|
* Aggregate Return::
|
|
|
|
* Caller Saves::
|
|
|
|
* Function Entry::
|
|
|
|
* Profiling::
|
|
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Frame Layout
|
|
|
|
@subsection Basic Stack Layout
|
|
|
|
@cindex stack frame layout
|
|
|
|
@cindex frame layout
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
Here is the basic stack layout.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
|
|
|
|
pointer to a smaller address.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{},'' it means that the
|
|
|
|
compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
|
|
|
|
definition used does not matter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
|
|
|
@item FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the addresses of local variable slots are at negative
|
|
|
|
offsets from the frame pointer.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
|
|
|
|
@item ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
|
|
|
|
addresses on the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
|
|
|
|
@item STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
|
|
|
|
Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
|
|
|
|
subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
|
|
|
|
Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
|
|
|
|
value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
|
|
|
|
@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
|
|
|
|
@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
|
|
|
|
Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
|
|
|
|
outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
|
|
|
|
zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
|
|
|
|
the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FIRST_PARM_OFFSET
|
|
|
|
@item FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
|
|
|
|
Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
|
|
|
|
address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
function.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
|
|
|
|
the first argument's address.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
|
|
|
|
Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
|
|
|
|
on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
|
|
|
|
length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
|
|
|
|
machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS
|
|
|
|
@item DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
|
|
|
|
A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
|
|
|
|
frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
|
|
|
|
@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
|
|
|
|
itself.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
|
|
|
|
of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
|
|
|
|
address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@item SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
|
|
|
|
setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
|
|
|
|
on the Sparc, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
|
|
|
|
define this macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
|
|
|
|
@item BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression that contains an rtx that is used to store
|
|
|
|
the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
|
|
|
|
The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
|
|
|
|
machines. One reason you may need to define this macro is if
|
|
|
|
@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex RETURN_ADDR_RTX
|
|
|
|
@item RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
|
|
|
|
A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
|
|
|
|
the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
|
|
|
|
frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
|
|
|
|
@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is not way to
|
|
|
|
determine the return address of other frames.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
|
|
|
|
@item RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
|
|
|
|
Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
|
|
|
|
from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
|
|
|
|
@item INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
|
|
|
|
A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
|
|
|
|
incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
|
|
|
|
prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
|
|
|
|
value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
|
|
|
|
the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
|
|
|
|
debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
|
|
|
|
@item INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
|
|
|
|
A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
|
|
|
|
from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
|
|
|
|
frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
|
|
|
|
the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
|
|
|
|
previous frame, just before the call instruction.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
|
|
|
|
debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Stack Checking
|
|
|
|
@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
GNU CC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of
|
|
|
|
the stack, if the @samp{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of three ways:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GNU CC
|
|
|
|
will assume that you have arranged for stack checking to be done at
|
|
|
|
appropriate places in the configuration files, e.g., in
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}. GNU CC will do not other special processing.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and you defined a named pattern
|
|
|
|
called @code{check_stack} in your @file{md} file, GNU CC will call that
|
|
|
|
pattern with one argument which is the address to compare the stack
|
|
|
|
value against. You must arrange for this pattern to report an error if
|
|
|
|
the stack pointer is out of range.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
If neither of the above are true, GNU CC will generate code to periodically
|
|
|
|
``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
|
|
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Normally, you will use the default values of these macros, so GNU CC
|
|
|
|
will use the third approach.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
|
|
|
|
A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
|
|
|
|
machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
|
|
|
|
is require by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to have to stack
|
|
|
|
checking in some more efficient way than GNU CC's portable approach.
|
|
|
|
The default value of this macro is zero.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
|
|
|
|
An integer representing the interval at which GNU CC must generate stack
|
|
|
|
probe instructions. You will normally define this macro to be no larger
|
|
|
|
than the size of the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The
|
|
|
|
default value of 4096 is suitable for most systems.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
|
|
|
|
A integer which is nonzero if GNU CC should perform the stack probe
|
|
|
|
as a load instruction and zero if GNU CC should use a store instruction.
|
|
|
|
The default is zero, which is the most efficient choice on most systems.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
|
|
|
|
The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow,
|
|
|
|
for languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of
|
|
|
|
75 words should be adequate for most machines.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
|
|
|
|
The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GNU CC will generate probe
|
|
|
|
instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
|
|
|
|
stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
|
|
|
|
checking will not be reliable and GNU CC will issue a warning. The
|
|
|
|
default is chosen so that GNU CC only generates one instruction on most
|
|
|
|
systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
|
|
|
|
GNU CC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
|
|
|
|
represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
|
|
|
|
space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
|
|
|
|
You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
|
|
|
|
use the default of four words.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
|
|
|
|
The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GNU CC will place in the
|
|
|
|
fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
|
|
|
|
@samp{-fstack-check}.
|
|
|
|
GNU CC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
|
|
|
|
normally not need to override that default.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@need 2000
|
|
|
|
@node Frame Registers
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
|
|
|
|
fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
|
|
|
|
the hardware determines which register this is.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
@item FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
|
|
|
|
access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
|
|
|
|
hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
|
|
|
|
choose any register you wish for this purpose.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
@item HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
|
|
|
|
offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
|
|
|
|
allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
|
|
|
|
between these two locations). On those machines, define
|
|
|
|
@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
|
|
|
|
be used internally until the offset is known, and define
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
used for the frame pointer.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
|
|
|
|
is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
|
|
|
|
the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
|
|
|
|
completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
|
|
|
|
definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
|
|
|
|
@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
|
|
|
|
or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
|
|
|
|
@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
@item ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
|
|
|
|
the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
|
|
|
|
frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
|
|
|
|
register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
|
|
|
|
wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
|
|
|
|
pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
|
|
|
|
@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
|
|
|
|
(@pxref{Elimination}).
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
@item RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
|
|
|
|
access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
|
|
|
|
machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
|
|
|
|
pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
|
|
|
|
to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
|
|
|
|
@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
|
|
|
|
address from the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
@findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
@item STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
@itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
|
|
|
|
register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
|
|
|
|
function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
|
|
|
|
number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
|
|
|
|
these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
|
|
|
|
not be defined.@refill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
|
|
|
|
defined; instead, the next two macros should be defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STATIC_CHAIN
|
|
|
|
@findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
|
|
|
|
@item STATIC_CHAIN
|
|
|
|
@itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
|
|
|
|
If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros provide rtx giving
|
|
|
|
@code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
|
|
|
|
@code{STATIC_CHAIN} and @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING} give the locations
|
|
|
|
as seen by the calling and called functions, respectively. Often the former
|
|
|
|
will be at an offset from the stack pointer and the latter at an offset from
|
|
|
|
the frame pointer.@refill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex stack_pointer_rtx
|
|
|
|
@findex frame_pointer_rtx
|
|
|
|
@findex arg_pointer_rtx
|
|
|
|
The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
|
|
|
|
@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized prior to the use of these
|
|
|
|
macros and should be used to refer to those items.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the static chain is passed in a register, the two previous macros should
|
|
|
|
be defined instead.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Elimination
|
|
|
|
@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
|
|
|
|
@item FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
|
|
|
|
A C expression which is nonzero if a function must have and use a frame
|
|
|
|
pointer. This expression is evaluated in the reload pass. If its value is
|
|
|
|
nonzero the function will have a frame pointer.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The expression can in principle examine the current function and decide
|
|
|
|
according to the facts, but on most machines the constant 0 or the
|
|
|
|
constant 1 suffices. Use 0 when the machine allows code to be generated
|
|
|
|
with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space. Use 1
|
|
|
|
when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame pointer.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
|
|
|
|
without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
|
|
|
|
automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
|
|
|
|
@code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} says. You don't need to worry about
|
|
|
|
them.@refill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
|
|
|
|
register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
|
|
|
|
fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET
|
|
|
|
@findex get_frame_size
|
|
|
|
@item INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
|
|
|
|
between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
|
|
|
|
the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
|
|
|
|
such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
|
|
|
|
registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
|
|
|
|
need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
|
|
|
|
@code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} is defined to always be true; in that
|
|
|
|
case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ELIMINABLE_REGS
|
|
|
|
@item ELIMINABLE_REGS
|
|
|
|
If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
|
|
|
|
eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
|
|
|
|
defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
|
|
|
|
references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
|
|
|
|
of which specifies an original and replacement register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
|
|
|
|
the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
|
|
|
|
must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
|
|
|
|
replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
|
|
|
|
depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In this case, you might specify:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
|
|
|
|
@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
|
|
|
|
@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
|
|
|
|
@{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
|
|
|
|
specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CAN_ELIMINATE
|
|
|
|
@item CAN_ELIMINATE (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that returns non-zero if the compiler is allowed to try
|
|
|
|
to replace register number @var{from-reg} with register number
|
|
|
|
@var{to-reg}. This macro need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
|
|
|
|
is defined, and will usually be the constant 1, since most of the cases
|
|
|
|
preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
|
|
|
|
knows about.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET
|
|
|
|
@item INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
|
|
|
|
This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
|
|
|
|
specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
|
|
|
|
registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
|
|
|
|
defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LONGJMP_RESTORE_FROM_STACK
|
|
|
|
@item LONGJMP_RESTORE_FROM_STACK
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the @code{longjmp} function restores registers from
|
|
|
|
the stack frames, rather than from those saved specifically by
|
|
|
|
@code{setjmp}. Certain quantities must not be kept in registers across
|
|
|
|
a call to @code{setjmp} on such machines.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Stack Arguments
|
|
|
|
@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
|
|
|
|
@cindex arguments on stack
|
|
|
|
@cindex stack arguments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
|
|
|
|
on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
|
|
|
|
control passing certain arguments in registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
|
|
|
|
@item PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if an argument declared in a prototype as an
|
|
|
|
integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be passed as an
|
|
|
|
@code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain cases of
|
|
|
|
mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PUSH_ROUNDING
|
|
|
|
@item PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
|
|
|
|
stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the target machine does not have a push instruction, do not define
|
|
|
|
this macro. That directs GNU CC to use an alternate strategy: to
|
|
|
|
allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
|
|
|
|
it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On some machines, the definition
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
|
|
will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
|
|
|
|
to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
|
|
|
|
alignment. Then the definition should be
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
|
|
|
|
@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
|
|
|
|
@item ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
|
|
|
|
If defined, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
|
|
|
|
will be computed and placed into the variable
|
|
|
|
@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
|
|
|
|
onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
|
|
|
|
increase the stack frame size by this amount.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Defining both @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
|
|
|
|
is not proper.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
|
|
|
|
@item REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
|
|
|
|
allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
|
|
|
|
registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
|
|
|
|
arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
|
|
|
|
machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
|
|
|
|
which.
|
|
|
|
@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
|
|
|
|
@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
|
|
|
|
@findex FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
|
|
|
|
@item MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
|
|
|
|
@itemx FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{const_size}, @var{var_size})
|
|
|
|
Define these macros in addition to the one above if functions might
|
|
|
|
allocate stack space for arguments even when their values are passed
|
|
|
|
in registers. These should be used when the stack space allocated
|
|
|
|
for arguments in registers is not a simple constant independent of the
|
|
|
|
function declaration.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The value of the first macro is the size, in bytes, of the area that
|
|
|
|
we should initially assume would be reserved for arguments passed in registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The value of the second macro is the actual size, in bytes, of the area
|
|
|
|
that will be reserved for arguments passed in registers. This takes two
|
|
|
|
arguments: an integer representing the number of bytes of fixed sized
|
|
|
|
arguments on the stack, and a tree representing the number of bytes of
|
|
|
|
variable sized arguments on the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When these macros are defined, @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} will only be
|
|
|
|
called for libcall functions, the current function, or for a function
|
|
|
|
being called when it is known that such stack space must be allocated.
|
|
|
|
In each case this value can be easily computed.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When deciding whether a called function needs such stack space, and how
|
|
|
|
much space to reserve, GNU CC uses these two macros instead of
|
|
|
|
@code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
|
|
|
|
@item OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
|
|
|
|
Define this if it is the responsibility of the caller to allocate the area
|
|
|
|
reserved for arguments passed in registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
|
|
|
|
whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
|
|
|
|
@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
|
|
|
|
@item STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
|
|
|
|
stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
|
|
|
|
@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
|
|
|
|
@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
|
|
|
|
stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
|
|
|
|
suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
|
|
|
|
stack in its natural location.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex RETURN_POPS_ARGS
|
|
|
|
@item RETURN_POPS_ARGS (@var{fundecl}, @var{funtype}, @var{stack-size})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes of its own
|
|
|
|
arguments that a function pops on returning, or 0 if the
|
|
|
|
function pops no arguments and the caller must therefore pop them all
|
|
|
|
after the function returns.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
|
|
|
|
the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
From this you can obtain the DECL_MACHINE_ATTRIBUTES of the function.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
|
|
|
|
describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
|
|
|
|
From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
|
|
|
|
arguments (if known).
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
|
|
|
|
you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
|
|
|
|
by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
|
|
|
|
a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
|
|
|
|
in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@var{stack-size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
|
|
|
|
stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
|
|
|
|
argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On the Vax, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
|
|
|
|
of this macro is @var{stack-size}. On the 68000, using the standard
|
|
|
|
calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
|
|
|
|
the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
|
|
|
|
convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
|
|
|
|
arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
|
|
|
|
nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
|
|
|
|
@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
|
|
|
|
number of arguments.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Register Arguments
|
|
|
|
@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
|
|
|
|
@cindex arguments in registers
|
|
|
|
@cindex registers arguments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This section describes the macros which let you control how various
|
|
|
|
types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
|
|
|
|
the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_ARG
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
|
|
|
|
in a register, and which register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
|
|
|
|
arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
|
|
|
|
the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
|
|
|
|
(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
|
|
|
|
which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
|
|
|
|
correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
|
|
|
|
argument on the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For machines like the Vax and 68000, where normally all arguments are
|
|
|
|
pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX. This is
|
|
|
|
used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
|
|
|
|
of the @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
|
|
|
|
@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
|
|
|
|
describes where part of the argument is passed. In each @code{expr_list},
|
|
|
|
the first operand can be either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard register
|
|
|
|
in which to pass this part of the argument, or zero to pass the argument
|
|
|
|
on the stack. If this operand is a @code{reg}, then the mode indicates
|
|
|
|
how large this part of the argument is. The second operand of the
|
|
|
|
@code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives the offset in bytes
|
|
|
|
into the entire argument where this part starts.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
|
|
|
|
The usual way to make the ANSI library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
|
|
|
|
where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
|
|
|
|
nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
|
|
|
|
by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
|
|
|
|
You may use the macro @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})}
|
|
|
|
in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
|
|
|
|
type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
|
|
|
|
is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns non-zero for such an
|
|
|
|
argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
|
|
|
|
defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
|
|
|
|
a register.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
|
|
|
|
@item MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})
|
|
|
|
Define as a C expression that evaluates to nonzero if we do not know how
|
|
|
|
to pass TYPE solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
|
|
|
|
definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
|
|
|
|
documentation.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
|
|
|
|
that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
|
|
|
|
necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
|
|
|
|
argument.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
|
|
|
|
the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
|
|
|
|
be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
|
|
|
|
where the arguments will arrive.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
|
|
|
|
serves both purposes.@refill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the number of words, at the beginning of an
|
|
|
|
argument, must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
|
|
|
|
arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
|
|
|
|
pushed on the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
|
|
|
|
registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
|
|
|
|
first @var{n} words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
|
|
|
|
on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
|
|
|
|
structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
|
|
|
|
in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
|
|
|
|
compiler when this occurs, and how many of the words should go in
|
|
|
|
registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
|
|
|
|
register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that indicates when an argument must be passed by reference.
|
|
|
|
If nonzero for an argument, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
|
|
|
|
pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
|
|
|
|
The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
|
|
|
|
to that type.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On machines where @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is not defined, a suitable
|
|
|
|
definition of this macro might be
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
#define FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE\
|
|
|
|
(CUM, MODE, TYPE, NAMED) \
|
|
|
|
MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (MODE, TYPE)
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@c this is *still* too long. --mew 5feb93
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression that indicates when it is the called function's
|
|
|
|
responsibility to make a copy of arguments passed by invisible reference.
|
|
|
|
Normally, the caller makes a copy and passes the address of the copy to the
|
|
|
|
routine being called. When FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES is defined and is
|
|
|
|
nonzero, the caller does not make a copy. Instead, it passes a pointer to the
|
|
|
|
``live'' value. The called function must not modify this value. If it can be
|
|
|
|
determined that the value won't be modified, it need not make a copy;
|
|
|
|
otherwise a copy must be made.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CUMULATIVE_ARGS
|
|
|
|
@item CUMULATIVE_ARGS
|
|
|
|
A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
|
|
|
|
the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
|
|
|
|
argument so far.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
|
|
|
|
arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
|
|
|
|
variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
|
|
|
|
arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
|
|
|
|
@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
|
|
|
|
should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@item INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{indirect})
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable @var{cum}
|
|
|
|
for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The variable has
|
|
|
|
type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype} is the tree node
|
|
|
|
for the data type of the function which will receive the args, or 0
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
if the args are to a compiler support library function. The value of
|
|
|
|
@var{indirect} is nonzero when processing an indirect call, for example
|
|
|
|
a call through a function pointer. The value of @var{indirect} is zero
|
|
|
|
for a call to an explicitly named function, a library function call, or when
|
|
|
|
@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
|
|
|
|
being compiled.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
|
|
|
|
@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
|
|
|
|
contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
|
|
|
|
an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
|
|
|
|
macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
|
|
|
|
never both of them at once.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS
|
|
|
|
@item INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
|
|
|
|
Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
|
|
|
|
finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
|
|
|
|
undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
|
|
|
|
with special calling conventions are never compiled with GNU CC. The
|
|
|
|
argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
|
|
|
|
@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
|
|
|
|
@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
|
|
|
|
@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
|
|
|
|
@var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
|
|
|
|
values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
|
|
|
|
Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
|
|
|
|
the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.@refill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
|
|
|
|
on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
|
|
|
|
used for arguments without any special help.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
|
|
|
|
to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
|
|
|
|
@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
|
|
|
|
@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
|
|
|
|
multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
|
|
|
|
it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
|
|
|
|
For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
|
|
|
|
big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
|
|
|
|
constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
of an argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
|
|
|
|
register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
|
|
|
|
@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
|
|
|
|
the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
|
|
|
|
used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
|
|
|
|
stack.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
|
|
|
|
@item LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
|
|
|
|
If defined, the order in which arguments are loaded into their
|
|
|
|
respective argument registers is reversed so that the last
|
|
|
|
argument is loaded first. This macro only effects arguments
|
|
|
|
passed in registers.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Scalar Return
|
|
|
|
@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
|
|
|
|
@cindex return values in registers
|
|
|
|
@cindex values, returned by functions
|
|
|
|
@cindex scalars, returned as values
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
|
|
|
|
values---values that can fit in registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex TRADITIONAL_RETURN_FLOAT
|
|
|
|
@item TRADITIONAL_RETURN_FLOAT
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Define this macro if @samp{-traditional} should not cause functions
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
declared to return @code{float} to convert the value to @code{double}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_VALUE
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
|
|
|
|
A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a
|
|
|
|
function returns a value of data type @var{valtype}. @var{valtype} is
|
|
|
|
a tree node representing a data type. Write @code{TYPE_MODE
|
|
|
|
(@var{valtype})} to get the machine mode used to represent that type.
|
|
|
|
On many machines, only the mode is relevant. (Actually, on most
|
|
|
|
machines, scalar values are returned in the same place regardless of
|
|
|
|
mode).@refill
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
The value of the expression is usually a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
|
|
|
|
register where the return value is stored. The value can also be a
|
|
|
|
@code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in multiple places. See
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the @code{parallel} form.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
If @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} is defined, you must apply the same
|
|
|
|
promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if @var{valtype} is a
|
|
|
|
scalar type.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
|
|
|
|
node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
|
|
|
|
pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
|
|
|
|
convention for specific functions when all their calls are
|
|
|
|
known.@refill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return vales with aggregate data
|
|
|
|
types, because these are returned in another way. See
|
|
|
|
@code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows''
|
|
|
|
so that the register in which a function returns its value is not
|
|
|
|
the same as the one in which the caller sees the value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} computes the register in which
|
|
|
|
the caller will see the value. @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} should be
|
|
|
|
defined in a similar fashion to tell the function where to put the
|
|
|
|
value.@refill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not defined,
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_VALUE} serves both purposes.@refill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not used for return vales with
|
|
|
|
aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
|
|
|
|
@code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LIBCALL_VALUE
|
|
|
|
@item LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
|
|
|
|
A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
|
|
|
|
function returns a value of mode @var{mode}. If the precise function
|
|
|
|
being called is known, @var{func} is a tree node
|
|
|
|
(@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
|
|
|
|
pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
|
|
|
|
convention for specific functions when all their calls are
|
|
|
|
known.@refill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
|
|
|
|
support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
|
|
|
|
specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
|
|
|
|
compiled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The definition of @code{LIBRARY_VALUE} need not be concerned aggregate
|
|
|
|
data types, because none of the library functions returns such types.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
|
|
|
|
register in which the values of called function may come back.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
|
|
|
|
second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
|
|
|
|
recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
|
|
|
|
suffices:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
|
|
|
|
function use different registers for the return value, this macro
|
|
|
|
should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
|
|
|
|
need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
|
|
|
|
saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Aggregate Return
|
|
|
|
@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
|
|
|
|
@cindex aggregates as return values
|
|
|
|
@cindex large return values
|
|
|
|
@cindex returning aggregate values
|
|
|
|
@cindex structure value address
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
|
|
|
|
cases), the value is not returned according to @code{FUNCTION_VALUE}
|
|
|
|
(@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the caller passes the address of a
|
|
|
|
block of memory in which the value should be stored. This address
|
|
|
|
is called the @dfn{structure value address}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This section describes how to control returning structure values in
|
|
|
|
memory.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex RETURN_IN_MEMORY
|
|
|
|
@item RETURN_IN_MEMORY (@var{type})
|
|
|
|
A C expression which can inhibit the returning of certain function
|
|
|
|
values in registers, based on the type of value. A nonzero value says
|
|
|
|
to return the function value in memory, just as large structures are
|
|
|
|
always returned. Here @var{type} will be a C expression of type
|
|
|
|
@code{tree}, representing the data type of the value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
|
|
|
|
by this macro. Also, the option @samp{-fpcc-struct-return}
|
|
|
|
takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
|
|
|
|
possible to leave the macro undefined; this causes a default
|
|
|
|
definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
|
|
|
|
values, and 0 otherwise.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not use this macro to indicate that structures and unions should always
|
|
|
|
be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
|
|
|
|
to indicate this.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
|
|
|
|
@item DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
|
|
|
|
in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
|
|
|
|
only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI.
|
|
|
|
If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
|
|
|
|
and union return values are decided by the @code{RETURN_IN_MEMORY} macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
@item STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
If the structure value address is passed in a register, then
|
|
|
|
@code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} should be the number of that register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STRUCT_VALUE
|
|
|
|
@item STRUCT_VALUE
|
|
|
|
If the structure value address is not passed in a register, define
|
|
|
|
@code{STRUCT_VALUE} as an expression returning an RTX for the place
|
|
|
|
where the address is passed. If it returns 0, the address is passed as
|
|
|
|
an ``invisible'' first argument.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
@item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
On some architectures the place where the structure value address
|
|
|
|
is found by the called function is not the same place that the
|
|
|
|
caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
|
|
|
|
be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the incoming location of the structure value address is in a
|
|
|
|
register, define this macro as the register number.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
|
|
|
|
@item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
|
|
|
|
If the incoming location is not a register, then you should define
|
|
|
|
@code{STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING} as an expression for an RTX for where the
|
|
|
|
called function should find the value. If it should find the value on
|
|
|
|
the stack, define this to create a @code{mem} which refers to the frame
|
|
|
|
pointer. A definition of 0 means that the address is passed as an
|
|
|
|
``invisible'' first argument.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
|
|
|
|
@item PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
|
|
|
|
for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
|
|
|
|
the address of a static variable containing the value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
|
|
|
|
pass an address to the subroutine.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro has effect in @samp{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
|
|
|
|
nothing when you use @samp{-freg-struct-return} mode.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Caller Saves
|
|
|
|
@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you enable it, GNU CC can save registers around function calls. This
|
|
|
|
makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
|
|
|
|
must live across calls.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
|
|
|
|
@item DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if function calls on the target machine do not preserve
|
|
|
|
any registers; in other words, if @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} has 1
|
|
|
|
for all registers. This macro enables @samp{-fcaller-saves} by default.
|
|
|
|
Eventually that option will be enabled by default on all machines and both
|
|
|
|
the option and this macro will be eliminated.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE
|
|
|
|
@item CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
|
|
|
|
A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
|
|
|
|
a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
|
|
|
|
restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
|
|
|
|
this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
|
|
|
|
machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Function Entry
|
|
|
|
@subsection Function Entry and Exit
|
|
|
|
@cindex function entry and exit
|
|
|
|
@cindex prologue
|
|
|
|
@cindex epilogue
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This section describes the macros that output function entry
|
|
|
|
(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{size})
|
|
|
|
A C compound statement that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
|
|
|
|
function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
|
|
|
|
initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
|
|
|
|
saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
|
|
|
|
local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
|
|
|
|
stream to which the assembler code should be output.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
|
|
|
|
macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex regs_ever_live
|
|
|
|
To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
|
|
|
|
@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
|
|
|
|
@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
|
|
|
|
prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
|
|
|
|
call-used registers. (@code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
|
|
|
|
@code{regs_ever_live}.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
|
|
|
|
not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
|
|
|
|
they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
|
|
|
|
appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
|
|
|
|
registers are used in the function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex frame_pointer_needed
|
|
|
|
On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
|
|
|
|
function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
|
|
|
|
pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
|
|
|
|
frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
|
|
|
|
@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
|
|
|
|
time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
|
|
|
|
required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
|
|
|
|
listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
|
|
|
|
order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
|
|
|
|
stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
|
|
|
|
the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
|
|
|
|
for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
|
|
|
|
compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
|
|
|
|
or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
|
|
|
|
need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
|
|
|
|
A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
|
|
|
|
uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
|
|
|
|
stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
|
|
|
|
if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
|
|
|
|
arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
|
|
|
|
yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
|
|
|
|
region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
|
|
|
|
registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
|
|
|
|
features in @file{varargs.h} and @file{stdargs.h}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
|
|
|
|
The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
|
|
|
|
the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
|
|
|
|
machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
|
|
|
|
in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
|
|
|
|
a save area.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
|
|
|
|
boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
|
|
|
|
this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
|
|
|
|
save area closer to the top of the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
|
|
|
|
Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
|
|
|
|
@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
|
|
|
|
argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
|
|
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Normally, it is necessary for the macros @code{FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to treat leaf functions specially. The C
|
|
|
|
variable @code{leaf_function} is nonzero for such a function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
|
|
|
|
@item EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
|
|
|
|
instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
|
|
|
|
pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
|
|
|
|
adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
|
|
|
|
frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
|
|
|
|
stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
|
|
|
|
compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex EPILOGUE_USES
|
|
|
|
@item EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers are
|
|
|
|
used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
|
|
|
|
pointer registers are already be assumed to be used as needed.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (@var{file}, @var{size})
|
|
|
|
A C compound statement that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
|
|
|
|
function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
|
|
|
|
registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
|
|
|
|
called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
|
|
|
|
same arguments as the macro @code{FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
|
|
|
|
registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
|
|
|
|
@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
|
|
|
|
of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
|
|
|
|
instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target switches
|
|
|
|
to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used, define a
|
|
|
|
@samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the target
|
|
|
|
switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
|
|
|
|
condition is false, epilogues will be used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
|
|
|
|
function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
|
|
|
|
two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
|
|
|
|
is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
|
|
|
|
@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
|
|
|
|
a function that needs a frame pointer.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Normally, @code{FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and @code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must
|
|
|
|
treat leaf functions specially. The C variable @code{leaf_function} is
|
|
|
|
nonzero for such a function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
|
|
|
|
others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
|
|
|
|
given @samp{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
|
|
|
|
number of arguments.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex current_function_pops_args
|
|
|
|
Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
|
|
|
|
functions pop their own arguments. @code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} needs to
|
|
|
|
know what was decided. The variable that is called
|
|
|
|
@code{current_function_pops_args} is the number of bytes of its
|
|
|
|
arguments that a function should pop. @xref{Scalar Return}.
|
|
|
|
@c what is the "its arguments" in the above sentence referring to, pray
|
|
|
|
@c tell? --mew 5feb93
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
|
|
|
|
@item DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
|
|
|
|
instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
|
|
|
|
definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
|
|
|
|
representing the number of delay slots there.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY
|
|
|
|
@item ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
|
|
|
|
slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
|
|
|
|
being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
|
|
|
|
eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
|
|
|
|
of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
|
|
|
|
If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
|
|
|
|
may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
|
|
|
|
(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
|
|
|
|
slot.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
|
|
|
|
@findex final_scan_insn
|
|
|
|
The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
|
|
|
|
list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
|
|
|
|
@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
|
|
|
|
delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by outputting the
|
|
|
|
insns in this list, usually by calling @code{final_scan_insn}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if you did not define
|
|
|
|
@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (@var{file}, @var{thunk_fndecl}, @var{delta}, @var{function})
|
|
|
|
A C compound statement that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
|
|
|
|
function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
|
|
|
|
inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
|
|
|
|
adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
|
|
|
|
the real function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
|
|
|
|
contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
|
|
|
|
contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
|
|
|
|
in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
|
|
|
|
e.g. @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
|
|
|
|
all other incoming arguments.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
After the addition, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
|
|
|
|
not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
|
|
|
|
return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
|
|
|
|
the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
|
|
|
|
of the code for a thunk function; @code{FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
|
|
|
|
have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
|
|
|
|
some targets, but probably not.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
|
|
|
|
frontend will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
|
|
|
|
@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
|
|
|
|
not support varargs.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Profiling
|
|
|
|
@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
|
|
|
|
@cindex profiling, code generation
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_PROFILER
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
|
|
|
|
A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
|
|
|
|
assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
|
|
|
|
Before calling, the assembler code must load the address of a
|
|
|
|
counter variable into a register where @code{mcount} expects to
|
|
|
|
find the address. The name of this variable is @samp{LP} followed
|
|
|
|
by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate the name using
|
|
|
|
@samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex mcount
|
|
|
|
The details of how the address should be passed to @code{mcount} are
|
|
|
|
determined by your operating system environment, not by GNU CC. To
|
|
|
|
figure them out, compile a small program for profiling using the
|
|
|
|
system's installed C compiler and look at the assembler code that
|
|
|
|
results.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
|
|
|
|
@item PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
|
|
|
|
the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@vindex profile_block_flag
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
|
|
|
|
A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
|
|
|
|
assembler code to initialize basic-block profiling for the current
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
object module. The global compile flag @code{profile_block_flag}
|
|
|
|
distinguishes two profile modes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex __bb_init_func
|
|
|
|
@item profile_block_flag != 2
|
|
|
|
Output code to call the subroutine @code{__bb_init_func} once per
|
|
|
|
object module, passing it as its sole argument the address of a block
|
|
|
|
allocated in the object module.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The name of the block is a local symbol made with this statement:
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{buffer}, "LPBX", 0);
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Of course, since you are writing the definition of
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} as well as that of this macro, you
|
|
|
|
can take a short cut in the definition of this macro and use the name
|
|
|
|
that you know will result.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The first word of this block is a flag which will be nonzero if the
|
|
|
|
object module has already been initialized. So test this word first,
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
and do not call @code{__bb_init_func} if the flag is
|
|
|
|
nonzero. BLOCK_OR_LABEL contains a unique number which may be used to
|
|
|
|
generate a label as a branch destination when @code{__bb_init_func}
|
|
|
|
will not be called.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Described in assembler language, the code to be output looks like:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
cmp (LPBX0),0
|
|
|
|
bne local_label
|
|
|
|
parameter1 <- LPBX0
|
|
|
|
call __bb_init_func
|
|
|
|
local_label:
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex __bb_init_trace_func
|
|
|
|
@item profile_block_flag == 2
|
|
|
|
Output code to call the subroutine @code{__bb_init_trace_func}
|
|
|
|
and pass two parameters to it. The first parameter is the same as
|
|
|
|
for @code{__bb_init_func}. The second parameter is the number of the
|
|
|
|
first basic block of the function as given by BLOCK_OR_LABEL. Note
|
|
|
|
that @code{__bb_init_trace_func} has to be called, even if the object
|
|
|
|
module has been initialized already.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Described in assembler language, the code to be output looks like:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
parameter1 <- LPBX0
|
|
|
|
parameter2 <- BLOCK_OR_LABEL
|
|
|
|
call __bb_init_trace_func
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex BLOCK_PROFILER
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@vindex profile_block_flag
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@item BLOCK_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{blockno})
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
|
|
|
|
assembler code to increment the count associated with the basic
|
|
|
|
block number @var{blockno}. The global compile flag
|
|
|
|
@code{profile_block_flag} distinguishes two profile modes.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@item profile_block_flag != 2
|
|
|
|
Output code to increment the counter directly. Basic blocks are
|
|
|
|
numbered separately from zero within each compilation. The count
|
|
|
|
associated with block number @var{blockno} is at index
|
|
|
|
@var{blockno} in a vector of words; the name of this array is a local
|
|
|
|
symbol made with this statement:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{buffer}, "LPBX", 2);
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c This paragraph is the same as one a few paragraphs up.
|
|
|
|
@c That is not an error.
|
|
|
|
Of course, since you are writing the definition of
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} as well as that of this macro, you
|
|
|
|
can take a short cut in the definition of this macro and use the name
|
|
|
|
that you know will result.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Described in assembler language, the code to be output looks like:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
inc (LPBX2+4*BLOCKNO)
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@vindex __bb
|
|
|
|
@findex __bb_trace_func
|
|
|
|
@item profile_block_flag == 2
|
|
|
|
Output code to initialize the global structure @code{__bb} and
|
|
|
|
call the function @code{__bb_trace_func}, which will increment the
|
|
|
|
counter.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@code{__bb} consists of two words. In the first word, the current
|
|
|
|
basic block number, as given by BLOCKNO, has to be stored. In
|
|
|
|
the second word, the address of a block allocated in the object
|
|
|
|
module has to be stored. The address is given by the label created
|
|
|
|
with this statement:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{buffer}, "LPBX", 0);
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Described in assembler language, the code to be output looks like:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
move BLOCKNO -> (__bb)
|
|
|
|
move LPBX0 -> (__bb+4)
|
|
|
|
call __bb_trace_func
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER_EXIT
|
|
|
|
@findex __bb_trace_ret
|
|
|
|
@vindex profile_block_flag
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER_EXIT (@var{file})
|
|
|
|
A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file}
|
|
|
|
assembler code to call function @code{__bb_trace_ret}. The
|
|
|
|
assembler code should only be output
|
|
|
|
if the global compile flag @code{profile_block_flag} == 2. This
|
|
|
|
macro has to be used at every place where code for returning from
|
|
|
|
a function is generated (e.g. @code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}). Although
|
|
|
|
you have to write the definition of @code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
|
|
|
|
as well, you have to define this macro to tell the compiler, that
|
|
|
|
the proper call to @code{__bb_trace_ret} is produced.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MACHINE_STATE_SAVE
|
|
|
|
@findex __bb_init_trace_func
|
|
|
|
@findex __bb_trace_func
|
|
|
|
@findex __bb_trace_ret
|
|
|
|
@item MACHINE_STATE_SAVE (@var{id})
|
|
|
|
A C statement or compound statement to save all registers, which may
|
|
|
|
be clobbered by a function call, including condition codes. The
|
|
|
|
@code{asm} statement will be mostly likely needed to handle this
|
|
|
|
task. Local labels in the assembler code can be concatenated with the
|
|
|
|
string @var{id}, to obtain a unique lable name.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Registers or condition codes clobbered by @code{FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} or
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must be saved in the macros
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER}, @code{FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER_EXIT} and
|
|
|
|
@code{BLOCK_PROFILER} prior calling @code{__bb_init_trace_func},
|
|
|
|
@code{__bb_trace_ret} and @code{__bb_trace_func} respectively.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MACHINE_STATE_RESTORE
|
|
|
|
@findex __bb_init_trace_func
|
|
|
|
@findex __bb_trace_func
|
|
|
|
@findex __bb_trace_ret
|
|
|
|
@item MACHINE_STATE_RESTORE (@var{id})
|
|
|
|
A C statement or compound statement to restore all registers, including
|
|
|
|
condition codes, saved by @code{MACHINE_STATE_SAVE}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Registers or condition codes clobbered by @code{FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} or
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must be restored in the macros
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER}, @code{FUNCTION_BLOCK_PROFILER_EXIT} and
|
|
|
|
@code{BLOCK_PROFILER} after calling @code{__bb_init_trace_func},
|
|
|
|
@code{__bb_trace_ret} and @code{__bb_trace_func} respectively.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex BLOCK_PROFILER_CODE
|
|
|
|
@item BLOCK_PROFILER_CODE
|
|
|
|
A C function or functions which are needed in the library to
|
|
|
|
support block profiling.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Varargs
|
|
|
|
@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
|
|
|
|
@cindex varargs implementation
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
GNU CC comes with an implementation of @file{varargs.h} and
|
|
|
|
@file{stdarg.h} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
|
|
|
|
on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
|
|
|
|
varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
|
|
|
|
conditionals to include it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ANSI @file{stdarg.h} differs from traditional @file{varargs.h} mainly in
|
|
|
|
the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
|
|
|
|
implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
|
|
|
|
to store the argument pointer. The ANSI implementation of
|
|
|
|
@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
|
|
|
|
supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
|
|
|
|
the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
|
|
|
|
below.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex __builtin_saveregs
|
|
|
|
@item __builtin_saveregs ()
|
|
|
|
Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
|
|
|
|
that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ANSI and traditional
|
|
|
|
versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
|
|
|
|
you use @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
|
|
|
|
control of the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On other machines,
|
|
|
|
it calls a routine written in assembler language, found in
|
|
|
|
@file{libgcc2.c}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
|
|
|
|
beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
|
|
|
|
@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
|
|
|
|
This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
|
|
|
|
to use them for its own purposes.
|
|
|
|
@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@c 10feb93
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex __builtin_args_info
|
|
|
|
@item __builtin_args_info (@var{category})
|
|
|
|
Use this built-in function to find the first anonymous arguments in
|
|
|
|
registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In general, a machine may have several categories of registers used for
|
|
|
|
arguments, each for a particular category of data types. (For example,
|
|
|
|
on some machines, floating-point registers are used for floating-point
|
|
|
|
arguments while other arguments are passed in the general registers.)
|
|
|
|
To make non-varargs functions use the proper calling convention, you
|
|
|
|
have defined the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data type to record how many
|
|
|
|
registers in each category have been used so far
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@code{__builtin_args_info} accesses the same data structure of type
|
|
|
|
@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} after the ordinary argument layout is finished
|
|
|
|
with it, with @var{category} specifying which word to access. Thus, the
|
|
|
|
value indicates the first unused register in a given category.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Normally, you would use @code{__builtin_args_info} in the implementation
|
|
|
|
of @code{va_start}, accessing each category just once and storing the
|
|
|
|
value in the @code{va_list} object. This is because @code{va_list} will
|
|
|
|
have to update the values, and there is no way to alter the
|
|
|
|
values accessed by @code{__builtin_args_info}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex __builtin_next_arg
|
|
|
|
@item __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
|
|
|
|
This is the equivalent of @code{__builtin_args_info}, for stack
|
|
|
|
arguments. It returns the address of the first anonymous stack
|
|
|
|
argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
|
|
|
|
returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
|
|
|
|
argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
|
|
|
|
fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
|
|
|
|
verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
|
|
|
|
of the current function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex __builtin_classify_type
|
|
|
|
@item __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
|
|
|
|
Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
|
|
|
|
passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
|
|
|
|
has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
|
|
|
|
specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
|
|
|
|
with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
|
|
|
|
considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
|
|
|
|
kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
|
|
|
|
interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
These machine description macros help implement varargs:
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
|
|
|
|
@item EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (@var{args})
|
|
|
|
If defined, is a C expression that produces the machine-specific code
|
|
|
|
for a call to @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the
|
|
|
|
very beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made.
|
|
|
|
The return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the
|
|
|
|
value to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The argument @var{args} is a @code{tree_list} containing the arguments
|
|
|
|
that were passed to @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, the compiler will output an ordinary
|
|
|
|
call to the library function @samp{__builtin_saveregs}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c !!! a bug in texinfo; how to make the entry on the @item line allow
|
|
|
|
@c more than one line of text... help... --mew 10feb93
|
|
|
|
@findex SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
|
|
|
|
@item SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (@var{args_so_far}, @var{mode}, @var{type},
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@var{pretend_args_size}, @var{second_time})
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
This macro offers an alternative to using @code{__builtin_saveregs} and
|
|
|
|
defining the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the
|
|
|
|
anonymous register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments
|
|
|
|
appear to have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is
|
|
|
|
done, you can use the standard implementation of varargs that works for
|
|
|
|
machines that pass all their arguments on the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The argument @var{args_so_far} is the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
|
|
|
|
structure, containing the values that obtain after processing of the
|
|
|
|
named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
|
|
|
|
last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The macro implementation should do two things: first, push onto the
|
|
|
|
stack all the argument registers @emph{not} used for the named
|
|
|
|
arguments, and second, store the size of the data thus pushed into the
|
|
|
|
@code{int}-valued variable whose name is supplied as the argument
|
|
|
|
@var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you store here will serve as
|
|
|
|
additional offset for setting up the stack frame.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
|
|
|
|
compile time without knowing their data types,
|
|
|
|
@code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that have just
|
|
|
|
a single category of argument register and use it uniformly for all data
|
|
|
|
types.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
|
|
|
|
arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
|
|
|
|
happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
|
|
|
|
end of the source file. The macro @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
|
|
|
|
not generate any instructions in this case.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
|
|
|
|
@item STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the location where a function
|
|
|
|
argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this macro returns a
|
|
|
|
nonzero value, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
|
|
|
|
arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns a value of
|
|
|
|
zero, but @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is defined, then all arguments
|
|
|
|
are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments except the last
|
|
|
|
are treated as named.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if it always returns zero.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Trampolines
|
|
|
|
@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
|
|
|
|
@cindex trampolines for nested functions
|
|
|
|
@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
|
|
|
|
when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
|
|
|
|
the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
|
|
|
|
tell GNU CC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
|
|
|
|
trampoline.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
|
|
|
|
address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
|
|
|
|
the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
|
|
|
|
two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
|
|
|
|
exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
|
|
|
|
machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
|
|
|
|
two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
|
|
|
|
operands.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
|
|
|
|
parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
|
|
|
|
immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
|
|
|
|
simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
|
|
|
|
proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
|
|
|
|
may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
|
|
|
|
separately.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
|
|
|
|
@item TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (@var{file})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output, on the stream @var{file}, assembler code for a
|
|
|
|
block of data that contains the constant parts of a trampoline. This
|
|
|
|
code should not include a label---the label is taken care of
|
|
|
|
automatically.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
If you do not define this macro, it means no template is needed
|
|
|
|
for the target. Do not define this macro on systems where the block move
|
|
|
|
code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
|
|
|
|
to generate it on the spot.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
|
|
|
|
@item TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
|
|
|
|
The name of a subroutine to switch to the section in which the
|
|
|
|
trampoline template is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}). The default is
|
|
|
|
a value of @samp{readonly_data_section}, which places the trampoline in
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
the section containing read-only data.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
@item TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
|
|
|
|
is used for aligning trampolines.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE
|
|
|
|
@item INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{addr}, @var{fnaddr}, @var{static_chain})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline.
|
|
|
|
@var{addr} is an RTX for the address of the trampoline; @var{fnaddr} is
|
|
|
|
an RTX for the address of the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
|
|
|
|
RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
|
|
|
|
when it is called.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE
|
|
|
|
@item ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{fp})
|
|
|
|
A C expression to allocate run-time space for a trampoline. The
|
|
|
|
expression value should be an RTX representing a memory reference to the
|
|
|
|
space for the trampoline.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} and trampolines
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and trampolines
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, by default the trampoline is allocated as
|
|
|
|
a stack slot. This default is right for most machines. The exceptions
|
|
|
|
are machines where it is impossible to execute instructions in the stack
|
|
|
|
area. On such machines, you may have to implement a separate stack,
|
|
|
|
using this macro in conjunction with @code{FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@var{fp} points to a data structure, a @code{struct function}, which
|
|
|
|
describes the compilation status of the immediate containing function of
|
|
|
|
the function which the trampoline is for. Normally (when
|
|
|
|
@code{ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE} is not defined), the stack slot for the
|
|
|
|
trampoline is in the stack frame of this containing function. Other
|
|
|
|
allocation strategies probably must do something analogous with this
|
|
|
|
information.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
|
|
|
|
separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
|
|
|
|
fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
|
|
|
|
jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
|
|
|
|
the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
|
|
|
|
make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
|
|
|
|
subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
|
|
|
|
latter makes initialization faster.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
|
|
|
|
the following macros which describe the shape of the cache.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex INSN_CACHE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item INSN_CACHE_SIZE
|
|
|
|
The total size in bytes of the cache.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
|
|
|
|
@item INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
|
|
|
|
The length in bytes of each cache line. The cache is divided into cache
|
|
|
|
lines which are disjoint slots, each holding a contiguous chunk of data
|
|
|
|
fetched from memory. Each time data is brought into the cache, an
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
entire line is read at once. The data loaded into a cache line is
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
always aligned on a boundary equal to the line size.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
|
|
|
|
@item INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
|
|
|
|
The number of alternative cache lines that can hold any particular memory
|
|
|
|
location.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Alternatively, if the machine has system calls or instructions to clear
|
|
|
|
the instruction cache directly, you can define the following macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex CLEAR_INSN_CACHE
|
|
|
|
@item CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{BEG}, @var{END})
|
|
|
|
If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
|
|
|
|
cache} in the specified interval. If it is not defined, and the macro
|
|
|
|
INSN_CACHE_SIZE is defined, some generic code is generated to clear the
|
|
|
|
cache. The definition of this macro would typically be a series of
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{asm} statements. Both @var{BEG} and @var{END} are both pointer
|
|
|
|
expressions.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
|
|
|
|
you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
|
|
|
|
cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
|
|
|
|
beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
|
|
|
|
its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
|
|
|
|
@item TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
|
|
|
|
work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
|
|
|
|
which will be compiled with GNU CC. They go in a library function named
|
|
|
|
@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
|
|
|
|
C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
|
|
|
|
special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
|
|
|
|
statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
|
|
|
|
global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
|
|
|
|
special assembler code.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Library Calls
|
|
|
|
@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
|
|
|
|
@cindex library subroutine names
|
|
|
|
@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex MULSI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
@item MULSI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
|
|
|
|
multiplication of one signed full-word by another. If you do not
|
|
|
|
define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__mulsi3},
|
|
|
|
a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DIVSI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
@item DIVSI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
|
|
|
|
division of one signed full-word by another. If you do not define
|
|
|
|
this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divsi3}, a
|
|
|
|
function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
@item UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
|
|
|
|
division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do not define
|
|
|
|
this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivsi3}, a
|
|
|
|
function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MODSI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
@item MODSI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
|
|
|
|
remainder in division of one signed full-word by another. If you do
|
|
|
|
not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
|
|
|
|
@code{__modsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex UMODSI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
@item UMODSI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
|
|
|
|
remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do
|
|
|
|
not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
|
|
|
|
@code{__umodsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MULDI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
@item MULDI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
|
|
|
|
multiplication of one signed double-word by another. If you do not
|
|
|
|
define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__muldi3},
|
|
|
|
a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DIVDI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
@item DIVDI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
|
|
|
|
division of one signed double-word by another. If you do not define
|
|
|
|
this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divdi3}, a
|
|
|
|
function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
@item UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
|
|
|
|
division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do not define
|
|
|
|
this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivdi3}, a
|
|
|
|
function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MODDI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
@item MODDI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
|
|
|
|
remainder in division of one signed double-word by another. If you do
|
|
|
|
not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
|
|
|
|
@code{__moddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex UMODDI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
@item UMODDI3_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
|
|
|
|
remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do
|
|
|
|
not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
|
|
|
|
@code{__umoddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
|
|
|
|
@item INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C statement that declares additional library
|
|
|
|
routines renames existing ones. @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after
|
|
|
|
initializing all the normal library routines.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex TARGET_EDOM
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
|
|
|
|
@item TARGET_EDOM
|
|
|
|
The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
|
|
|
|
expression. If you don't define this macro, GNU CC does not attempt to
|
|
|
|
deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
|
|
|
|
@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
|
|
|
|
system.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
|
|
|
|
domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
|
|
|
|
error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
|
|
|
|
there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
|
|
|
|
that @code{matherr} is used normally.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex GEN_ERRNO_RTX
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
|
|
|
|
@item GEN_ERRNO_RTX
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
|
|
|
|
refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
|
|
|
|
@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
|
|
|
|
macro, a reasonable default is used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{bcopy}, implicit usage
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{memcpy}, implicit usage
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{bzero}, implicit usage
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{memset}, implicit usage
|
|
|
|
@item TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if GNU CC should generate calls to the System V
|
|
|
|
(and ANSI C) library functions @code{memcpy} and @code{memset}
|
|
|
|
rather than the BSD functions @code{bcopy} and @code{bzero}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
|
|
|
|
@item LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if only @code{float} arguments cannot be passed to
|
|
|
|
library routines (so they must be converted to @code{double}). This
|
|
|
|
macro affects both how library calls are generated and how the library
|
|
|
|
routines in @file{libgcc1.c} accept their arguments. It is useful on
|
|
|
|
machines where floating and fixed point arguments are passed
|
|
|
|
differently, such as the i860.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FLOAT_ARG_TYPE
|
|
|
|
@item FLOAT_ARG_TYPE
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to override the type used by the library routines to
|
|
|
|
pick up arguments of type @code{float}. (By default, they use a union
|
|
|
|
of @code{float} and @code{int}.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The obvious choice would be @code{float}---but that won't work with
|
|
|
|
traditional C compilers that expect all arguments declared as @code{float}
|
|
|
|
to arrive as @code{double}. To avoid this conversion, the library routines
|
|
|
|
ask for the value as some other type and then treat it as a @code{float}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On some systems, no other type will work for this. For these systems,
|
|
|
|
you must use @code{LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE} instead, to force conversion of
|
|
|
|
the values @code{double} before they are passed.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FLOATIFY
|
|
|
|
@item FLOATIFY (@var{passed-value})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to override the way library routines redesignate a
|
|
|
|
@code{float} argument as a @code{float} instead of the type it was
|
|
|
|
passed as. The default is an expression which takes the @code{float}
|
|
|
|
field of the union.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FLOAT_VALUE_TYPE
|
|
|
|
@item FLOAT_VALUE_TYPE
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to override the type used by the library routines to
|
|
|
|
return values that ought to have type @code{float}. (By default, they
|
|
|
|
use @code{int}.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The obvious choice would be @code{float}---but that won't work with
|
|
|
|
traditional C compilers gratuitously convert values declared as
|
|
|
|
@code{float} into @code{double}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INTIFY
|
|
|
|
@item INTIFY (@var{float-value})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to override the way the value of a
|
|
|
|
@code{float}-returning library routine should be packaged in order to
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
return it. These functions are actually declared to return type
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{FLOAT_VALUE_TYPE} (normally @code{int}).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
These values can't be returned as type @code{float} because traditional
|
|
|
|
C compilers would gratuitously convert the value to a @code{double}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A local variable named @code{intify} is always available when the macro
|
|
|
|
@code{INTIFY} is used. It is a union of a @code{float} field named
|
|
|
|
@code{f} and a field named @code{i} whose type is
|
|
|
|
@code{FLOAT_VALUE_TYPE} or @code{int}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the default definition works by copying
|
|
|
|
the value through that union.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex nongcc_SI_type
|
|
|
|
@item nongcc_SI_type
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as the name of the data type corresponding to
|
|
|
|
@code{SImode} in the system's own C compiler.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if that type is @code{long int}, as it usually
|
|
|
|
is.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex nongcc_word_type
|
|
|
|
@item nongcc_word_type
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Define this macro as the name of the data type corresponding to the
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
word_mode in the system's own C compiler.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if that type is @code{long int}, as it usually
|
|
|
|
is.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex perform_@dots{}
|
|
|
|
@item perform_@dots{}
|
|
|
|
Define these macros to supply explicit C statements to carry out various
|
|
|
|
arithmetic operations on types @code{float} and @code{double} in the
|
|
|
|
library routines in @file{libgcc1.c}. See that file for a full list
|
|
|
|
of these macros and their arguments.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On most machines, you don't need to define any of these macros, because
|
|
|
|
the C compiler that comes with the system takes care of doing them.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
|
|
|
|
@item NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to generate code for Objective C message sending using
|
|
|
|
the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
|
|
|
|
involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
|
|
|
|
at once to the method-lookup library function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
|
|
|
|
to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Addressing Modes
|
|
|
|
@section Addressing Modes
|
|
|
|
@cindex addressing modes
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
This is about addressing modes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
|
|
|
|
@item HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the machine supports post-increment addressing.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
|
|
|
|
@findex HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
|
|
|
|
@findex HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
|
|
|
|
@item HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
|
|
|
|
@itemx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
|
|
|
|
@itemx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
|
|
|
|
Similar for other kinds of addressing.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P
|
|
|
|
@item CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
|
|
|
|
is a valid address. On most machines, this can be defined as
|
|
|
|
@code{CONSTANT_P (@var{x})}, but a few machines are more restrictive
|
|
|
|
in which constant addresses are supported.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CONSTANT_P
|
|
|
|
@code{CONSTANT_P} accepts integer-values expressions whose values are
|
|
|
|
not explicitly known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and
|
|
|
|
@code{high} expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in
|
|
|
|
addition to @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
|
|
|
|
@item MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
|
|
|
|
A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
|
|
|
|
memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
|
|
|
|
the maximum number that @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} would ever
|
|
|
|
accept.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS
|
|
|
|
@item GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
|
|
|
|
A C compound statement with a conditional @code{goto @var{label};}
|
|
|
|
executed if @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory address on the
|
|
|
|
target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
It usually pays to define several simpler macros to serve as
|
|
|
|
subroutines for this one. Otherwise it may be too complicated to
|
|
|
|
understand.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro must exist in two variants: a strict variant and a
|
|
|
|
non-strict one. The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It
|
|
|
|
must be defined so that any pseudo-register that has not been
|
|
|
|
allocated a hard register is considered a memory reference. In
|
|
|
|
contexts where some kind of register is required, a pseudo-register
|
|
|
|
with no hard register must be rejected.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
|
|
|
|
accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
|
|
|
|
register is required.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REG_OK_STRICT
|
|
|
|
Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
|
|
|
|
macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
|
|
|
|
@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant
|
|
|
|
in that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subroutines to check for acceptable registers for various purposes (one
|
|
|
|
for base registers, one for index registers, and so on) are typically
|
|
|
|
among the subroutines used to define @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}.
|
|
|
|
Then only these subroutine macros need have two variants; the higher
|
|
|
|
levels of macros may be the same whether strict or not.@refill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
|
|
|
|
and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
|
|
|
|
constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
|
|
|
|
specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
|
|
|
|
recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
|
|
|
|
sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
|
|
|
|
@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
|
|
|
|
naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
|
|
|
|
be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
|
|
|
|
On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
|
|
|
|
the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
|
|
|
|
macro @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
|
|
|
|
@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
|
|
|
|
@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
|
|
|
|
@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
|
|
|
|
Format}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex saveable_obstack
|
|
|
|
The best way to modify the name string is by adding text to the
|
|
|
|
beginning, with suitable punctuation to prevent any ambiguity. Allocate
|
|
|
|
the new name in @code{saveable_obstack}. You will have to modify
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to remove and decode the added text and
|
|
|
|
output the name accordingly, and define @code{STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} to
|
|
|
|
access the original name string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You can check the information stored here into the @code{symbol_ref} in
|
|
|
|
the definitions of the macros @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and
|
|
|
|
@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P
|
|
|
|
@item REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
|
|
|
|
RTX) is valid for use as a base register. For hard registers, it
|
|
|
|
should always accept those which the hardware permits and reject the
|
|
|
|
others. Whether the macro accepts or rejects pseudo registers must be
|
|
|
|
controlled by @code{REG_OK_STRICT} as described above. This usually
|
|
|
|
requires two variant definitions, of which @code{REG_OK_STRICT}
|
|
|
|
controls the one actually used.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
|
|
|
|
@item REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x}, @var{mode})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that is just like @code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
|
|
|
|
that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
|
|
|
|
@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
|
|
|
|
reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
|
|
|
|
you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
|
|
|
|
@code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
|
|
|
|
@item REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{x})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
|
|
|
|
RTX) is valid for use as an index register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The difference between an index register and a base register is that
|
|
|
|
the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
|
|
|
|
two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
|
|
|
|
labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
|
|
|
|
labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
|
|
|
|
may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
|
|
|
|
looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
|
|
|
|
only if neither labeling works.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
|
|
|
|
@item LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{oldx}, @var{mode}, @var{win})
|
|
|
|
A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x} with a valid
|
|
|
|
memory address for an operand of mode @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a
|
|
|
|
C statement label elsewhere in the code; the macro definition may use
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{win});
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
|
|
to avoid further processing if the address has become legitimate.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex break_out_memory_refs
|
|
|
|
@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
|
|
|
|
and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
|
|
|
|
@var{x}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The code generated by this macro should not alter the substructure of
|
|
|
|
@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
|
|
|
|
should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
|
|
|
|
address. The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In
|
|
|
|
fact, it is safe for this macro to do nothing. But often a
|
|
|
|
machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS
|
|
|
|
@item LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
|
|
|
|
A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
|
|
|
|
that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
|
|
|
|
@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
|
|
|
|
It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
|
|
|
|
performance reasons.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
|
|
|
|
reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
|
|
|
|
registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
|
|
|
|
processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
|
|
|
|
needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
|
|
|
|
LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS appropriately, the intermediate addresses
|
|
|
|
generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
|
|
|
|
be shared.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
|
|
|
|
to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
|
|
|
|
and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
|
|
|
|
of reload internals.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
|
|
|
|
previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
|
|
|
|
then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex push_reload
|
|
|
|
The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
|
|
|
|
need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
|
|
|
|
suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
|
|
|
|
@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
|
|
|
|
should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
|
|
|
|
This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
|
|
|
|
@code{push_reload}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex strict_memory_address_p
|
|
|
|
The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
|
|
|
|
the address has become legitimate.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex copy_rtx
|
|
|
|
If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
|
|
|
|
this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that is unshares only a
|
|
|
|
single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
|
|
|
|
top level, you'll need to replace first the top leve
|
|
|
|
It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
|
|
|
|
address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS
|
|
|
|
@item GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
|
|
|
|
A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
|
|
|
|
@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
|
|
|
|
different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
|
|
|
|
reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
|
|
|
|
but not others.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
|
|
|
|
effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
|
|
|
|
of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
|
|
|
|
addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
|
|
|
|
@item LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
|
|
|
|
an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
|
|
|
|
@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
|
|
|
|
@samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
|
|
|
|
anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.@refill
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DONT_RECORD_EQUIVALENCE
|
|
|
|
@item DONT_RECORD_EQUIVALENCE (@var{note})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if the @code{REG_EQUAL} note @var{x} should not
|
|
|
|
be promoted to a @code{REG_EQUIV} note.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if @var{note} refers to a constant that must be accepted
|
|
|
|
by @code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P}, but must not appear as an immediate operand.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Most machine descriptions do not need to define this macro.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Condition Code
|
|
|
|
@section Condition Code Status
|
|
|
|
@cindex condition code status
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
This describes the condition code status.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex cc_status
|
|
|
|
The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
|
|
|
|
describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
|
|
|
|
the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
|
|
|
|
variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
|
|
|
|
currently based, and several standard flags.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
|
|
|
|
description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
|
|
|
|
information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex CC_STATUS_MDEP
|
|
|
|
@item CC_STATUS_MDEP
|
|
|
|
C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
|
|
|
|
component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
|
|
|
|
@item CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
|
|
|
|
A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
|
|
|
|
The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
|
|
|
|
the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
|
|
|
|
define this macro to initialize it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex NOTICE_UPDATE_CC
|
|
|
|
@item NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
|
|
|
|
A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
|
|
|
|
appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
|
|
|
|
this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
|
|
|
|
code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
|
|
|
|
set @code{(cc0)}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
|
|
|
|
other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
|
|
|
|
invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
|
|
|
|
reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
|
|
|
|
registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
|
|
|
|
@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
|
|
|
|
insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
|
|
|
|
based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
|
|
|
|
value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
|
|
|
|
this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
|
|
|
|
@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
|
|
|
|
@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
|
|
|
|
condition code value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
|
|
|
|
with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
|
|
|
|
@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
|
|
|
|
constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
|
|
|
|
insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
|
|
|
|
@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
|
|
|
|
@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
|
|
|
|
that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
|
|
|
|
@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
|
|
|
|
two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex EXTRA_CC_MODES
|
|
|
|
@item EXTRA_CC_MODES
|
|
|
|
A list of names to be used for additional modes for condition code
|
|
|
|
values in registers (@pxref{Jump Patterns}). These names are added
|
|
|
|
to @code{enum machine_mode} and all have class @code{MODE_CC}. By
|
|
|
|
convention, they should start with @samp{CC} and end with @samp{mode}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You should only define this macro if your machine does not use @code{cc0}
|
|
|
|
and only if additional modes are required.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex EXTRA_CC_NAMES
|
|
|
|
@item EXTRA_CC_NAMES
|
|
|
|
A list of C strings giving the names for the modes listed in
|
|
|
|
@code{EXTRA_CC_MODES}. For example, the Sparc defines this macro and
|
|
|
|
@code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} as
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
#define EXTRA_CC_MODES CC_NOOVmode, CCFPmode, CCFPEmode
|
|
|
|
#define EXTRA_CC_NAMES "CC_NOOV", "CCFP", "CCFPE"
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro is not required if @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is not defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SELECT_CC_MODE
|
|
|
|
@item SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
|
|
|
|
Returns a mode from class @code{MODE_CC} to be used when comparison
|
|
|
|
operation code @var{op} is applied to rtx @var{x} and @var{y}. For
|
|
|
|
example, on the Sparc, @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} is defined as (see
|
|
|
|
@pxref{Jump Patterns} for a description of the reason for this
|
|
|
|
definition)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
|
|
|
|
(GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
|
|
|
|
? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
|
|
|
|
: ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
|
|
|
|
|| GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
|
|
|
|
? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is not defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON
|
|
|
|
@item CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
|
|
|
|
One some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
|
|
|
|
convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
|
|
|
|
does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
|
|
|
|
comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
|
|
|
|
required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
|
|
|
|
and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
|
|
|
|
comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@var{op1} as required.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
GNU CC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
|
|
|
|
valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@file{md} file.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
|
|
|
|
code or operands.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE
|
|
|
|
@item REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
|
|
|
|
A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
|
|
|
|
comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
|
|
|
|
can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
|
|
|
|
then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
|
|
|
|
floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
|
|
|
|
For example, here is the definition used on the Sparc, where floating-point
|
|
|
|
inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Costs
|
|
|
|
@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
|
|
|
|
@cindex costs of instructions
|
|
|
|
@cindex relative costs
|
|
|
|
@cindex speed of instructions
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
|
|
|
|
on the target machine.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex CONST_COSTS
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@item CONST_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
|
|
|
|
A part of a C @code{switch} statement that describes the relative costs
|
|
|
|
of constant RTL expressions. It must contain @code{case} labels for
|
|
|
|
expression codes @code{const_int}, @code{const}, @code{symbol_ref},
|
|
|
|
@code{label_ref} and @code{const_double}. Each case must ultimately
|
|
|
|
reach a @code{return} statement to return the relative cost of the use
|
|
|
|
of that kind of constant value in an expression. The cost may depend on
|
|
|
|
the precise value of the constant, which is available for examination in
|
|
|
|
@var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression in which it is contained,
|
|
|
|
found in @var{outer_code}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@var{code} is the expression code---redundant, since it can be
|
|
|
|
obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex RTX_COSTS
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex COSTS_N_INSNS
|
|
|
|
@item RTX_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
|
|
|
|
Like @code{CONST_COSTS} but applies to nonconstant RTL expressions.
|
|
|
|
This can be used, for example, to indicate how costly a multiply
|
|
|
|
instruction is. In writing this macro, you can use the construct
|
|
|
|
@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
|
|
|
|
instructions. @var{outer_code} is the code of the expression in which
|
|
|
|
@var{x} is contained.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro is optional; do not define it if the default cost assumptions
|
|
|
|
are adequate for the target machine.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex DEFAULT_RTX_COSTS
|
|
|
|
@item DEFAULT_RTX_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
|
|
|
|
This macro, if defined, is called for any case not handled by the
|
|
|
|
@code{RTX_COSTS} or @code{CONST_COSTS} macros. This eliminates the need
|
|
|
|
to put case labels into the macro, but the code, or any functions it
|
|
|
|
calls, must assume that the RTL in @var{x} could be of any type that has
|
|
|
|
not already been handled. The arguments are the same as for
|
|
|
|
@code{RTX_COSTS}, and the macro should execute a return statement giving
|
|
|
|
the cost of any RTL expressions that it can handle. The default cost
|
|
|
|
calculation is used for any RTL for which this macro does not return a
|
|
|
|
value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro is optional; do not define it if the default cost assumptions
|
|
|
|
are adequate for the target machine.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex ADDRESS_COST
|
|
|
|
@item ADDRESS_COST (@var{address})
|
|
|
|
An expression giving the cost of an addressing mode that contains
|
|
|
|
@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
|
|
|
|
the @var{address} expression and the @code{CONST_COSTS} values.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
|
|
|
|
true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
|
|
|
|
instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
|
|
|
|
all addresses will have equal costs.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
|
|
|
|
the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
|
|
|
|
cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
|
|
|
|
and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
|
|
|
|
is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
|
|
|
|
references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
|
|
|
|
the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
|
|
|
|
that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
|
|
|
|
instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
|
|
|
|
specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Similar use of this macro is made in strength reduction of loops.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@var{address} need not be valid as an address. In such a case, the cost
|
|
|
|
is not relevant and can be any value; invalid addresses need not be
|
|
|
|
assigned a different cost.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
|
|
|
|
cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
|
|
|
|
@code{ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to be live
|
|
|
|
over a region of code where only one would have been if
|
|
|
|
@code{ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect should
|
|
|
|
be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs should
|
|
|
|
probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of registers
|
|
|
|
on machines with lots of registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro will normally either not be defined or be defined as a
|
|
|
|
constant.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REGISTER_MOVE_COST
|
|
|
|
@item REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{from}, @var{to})
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the cost of moving data from a register in class
|
|
|
|
@var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are expressed using
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A value of 2 is the
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
default; other values are interpreted relative to that.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
|
|
|
|
same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
|
|
|
|
registers if they are not general registers.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
|
|
|
|
hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
|
|
|
|
classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
|
|
|
|
constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
|
|
|
|
allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
|
|
|
|
if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MEMORY_MOVE_COST
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@item MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
|
|
|
|
register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
|
|
|
|
is to be written to memory, non-zero if it is to be read in. This cost
|
|
|
|
is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
|
|
|
|
registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
|
|
|
|
should define this macro to express the relative cost.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you do not define this macro, GNU CC uses a default cost of 4 plus
|
|
|
|
the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
|
|
|
|
needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
|
|
|
|
between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
|
|
|
|
more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
|
|
|
|
reflect the actual cost of the move.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
GNU CC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
|
|
|
|
secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
|
|
|
|
a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
|
|
|
|
secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
|
|
|
|
4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
|
|
|
|
value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
|
|
|
|
are the same as to this macro.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex BRANCH_COST
|
|
|
|
@item BRANCH_COST
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
|
|
|
|
the default; other values are interpreted relative to that.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
|
|
|
|
but only that certain actions are more expensive than GNU CC would
|
|
|
|
ordinarily expect.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
|
|
|
|
@item SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
|
|
|
|
than a word of memory (i.e. a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
|
|
|
|
faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
|
|
|
|
require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
|
|
|
|
between byte and (aligned) word loads.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
|
|
|
|
finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
|
|
|
|
load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
|
|
|
|
faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
|
|
|
|
may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
|
|
|
|
other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SLOW_ZERO_EXTEND
|
|
|
|
@item SLOW_ZERO_EXTEND
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if zero-extension (of a @code{char} or @code{short}
|
|
|
|
to an @code{int}) can be done faster if the destination is a register
|
|
|
|
that is known to be zero.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you define this macro, you must have instruction patterns that
|
|
|
|
recognize RTL structures like this:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
(set (strict_low_part (subreg:QI (reg:SI @dots{}) 0)) @dots{})
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
|
|
and likewise for @code{HImode}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
|
|
|
|
@item SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to be the value 1 if unaligned accesses have a cost
|
|
|
|
many times greater than aligned accesses, for example if they are
|
|
|
|
emulated in a trap handler.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When this macro is non-zero, the compiler will act as if
|
|
|
|
@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were non-zero when generating code for block
|
|
|
|
moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
|
|
|
|
Therefore, do not set this macro non-zero if unaligned accesses only add a
|
|
|
|
cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
|
|
|
|
@item DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to inhibit strength reduction of memory addresses.
|
|
|
|
(On some machines, such strength reduction seems to do harm rather
|
|
|
|
than good.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MOVE_RATIO
|
|
|
|
@item MOVE_RATIO
|
|
|
|
The number of scalar move insns which should be generated instead of a
|
|
|
|
string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
|
|
|
|
make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex NO_FUNCTION_CSE
|
|
|
|
@item NO_FUNCTION_CSE
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
|
|
|
|
function address than to call an address kept in a register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
|
|
|
|
@item NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if it is as good or better for a function to call
|
|
|
|
itself with an explicit address than to call an address kept in a
|
|
|
|
register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ADJUST_COST
|
|
|
|
@item ADJUST_COST (@var{insn}, @var{link}, @var{dep_insn}, @var{cost})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the integer variable @var{cost}
|
|
|
|
based on the relationship between @var{insn} that is dependent on
|
|
|
|
@var{dep_insn} through the dependence @var{link}. The default is to
|
|
|
|
make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example to
|
|
|
|
specify to the scheduler that an output- or anti-dependence does not
|
|
|
|
incur the same cost as a data-dependence.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ADJUST_PRIORITY
|
|
|
|
@item ADJUST_PRIORITY (@var{insn})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the integer scheduling
|
|
|
|
priority @code{INSN_PRIORITY(@var{insn})}. Reduce the priority
|
|
|
|
to execute the @var{insn} earlier, increase the priority to execute
|
|
|
|
@var{insn} later. Do not define this macro if you do not need to
|
|
|
|
adjust the scheduling priorities of insns.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Sections
|
|
|
|
@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
|
|
|
|
@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
|
|
|
|
@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
|
|
|
|
data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
|
|
|
|
section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
|
|
|
|
section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
|
|
|
|
section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
|
|
|
|
of sections.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The compiler must tell the assembler when to switch sections. These
|
|
|
|
macros control what commands to output to tell the assembler this. You
|
|
|
|
can also define additional sections.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
|
|
|
@item TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
|
|
|
A C expression whose value is a string containing the assembler
|
|
|
|
operation that should precede instructions and read-only data. Normally
|
|
|
|
@code{".text"} is right.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
|
|
|
@item DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
|
|
|
A C expression whose value is a string containing the assembler
|
|
|
|
operation to identify the following data as writable initialized data.
|
|
|
|
Normally @code{".data"} is right.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
|
|
|
@item SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
assembler operation to identify the following data as shared data. If
|
|
|
|
not defined, @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP} will be used.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
|
|
|
@item BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
|
|
|
|
assembler operation to identify the following data as uninitialized global
|
|
|
|
data. If not defined, and neither @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined, uninitialized global data will be
|
|
|
|
output in the data section if @samp{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
|
|
|
@item SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
|
|
|
|
assembler operation to identify the following data as uninitialized global
|
|
|
|
shared data. If not defined, and @code{BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP} is, the latter
|
|
|
|
will be used.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
|
|
|
@item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
assembler operation to identify the following data as initialization
|
|
|
|
code. If not defined, GNU CC will assume such a section does not
|
|
|
|
exist.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex EXTRA_SECTIONS
|
|
|
|
@findex in_text
|
|
|
|
@findex in_data
|
|
|
|
@item EXTRA_SECTIONS
|
|
|
|
A list of names for sections other than the standard two, which are
|
|
|
|
@code{in_text} and @code{in_data}. You need not define this macro
|
|
|
|
on a system with no other sections (that GCC needs to use).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
|
|
|
|
@findex text_section
|
|
|
|
@findex data_section
|
|
|
|
@item EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
|
|
|
|
One or more functions to be defined in @file{varasm.c}. These
|
|
|
|
functions should do jobs analogous to those of @code{text_section} and
|
|
|
|
@code{data_section}, for your additional sections. Do not define this
|
|
|
|
macro if you do not define @code{EXTRA_SECTIONS}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex READONLY_DATA_SECTION
|
|
|
|
@item READONLY_DATA_SECTION
|
|
|
|
On most machines, read-only variables, constants, and jump tables are
|
|
|
|
placed in the text section. If this is not the case on your machine,
|
|
|
|
this macro should be defined to be the name of a function (either
|
|
|
|
@code{data_section} or a function defined in @code{EXTRA_SECTIONS}) that
|
|
|
|
switches to the section to be used for read-only items.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If these items should be placed in the text section, this macro should
|
|
|
|
not be defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SELECT_SECTION
|
|
|
|
@item SELECT_SECTION (@var{exp}, @var{reloc})
|
|
|
|
A C statement or statements to switch to the appropriate section for
|
|
|
|
output of @var{exp}. You can assume that @var{exp} is either a
|
|
|
|
@code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of some sort. @var{reloc}
|
|
|
|
indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time
|
|
|
|
relocations. Select the section by calling @code{text_section} or one
|
|
|
|
of the alternatives for other sections.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if you put all read-only variables and
|
|
|
|
constants in the read-only data section (usually the text section).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SELECT_RTX_SECTION
|
|
|
|
@item SELECT_RTX_SECTION (@var{mode}, @var{rtx})
|
|
|
|
A C statement or statements to switch to the appropriate section for
|
|
|
|
output of @var{rtx} in mode @var{mode}. You can assume that @var{rtx}
|
|
|
|
is some kind of constant in RTL. The argument @var{mode} is redundant
|
|
|
|
except in the case of a @code{const_int} rtx. Select the section by
|
|
|
|
calling @code{text_section} or one of the alternatives for other
|
|
|
|
sections.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Do not define this macro if you put all constants in the read-only
|
|
|
|
data section.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
|
|
|
|
@item JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Define this macro to be an expression with a non-zero value if jump
|
|
|
|
tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
|
|
|
|
section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
|
|
|
|
readonly data section is used.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
|
|
|
|
@item ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (@var{decl})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if references to a symbol must be treated differently
|
|
|
|
depending on something about the variable or function named by the
|
|
|
|
symbol (such as what section it is in).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The macro definition, if any, is executed immediately after the rtl for
|
|
|
|
@var{decl} has been created and stored in @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}.
|
|
|
|
The value of the rtl will be a @code{mem} whose address is a
|
|
|
|
@code{symbol_ref}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
|
|
|
|
The usual thing for this macro to do is to record a flag in the
|
|
|
|
@code{symbol_ref} (such as @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}) or to store a
|
|
|
|
modified name string in the @code{symbol_ref} (if one bit is not enough
|
|
|
|
information).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
|
|
|
|
@item STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (@var{var}, @var{sym_name})
|
|
|
|
Decode @var{sym_name} and store the real name part in @var{var}, sans
|
|
|
|
the characters that encode section info. Define this macro if
|
|
|
|
@code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} alters the symbol's name string.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex UNIQUE_SECTION_P
|
|
|
|
@item UNIQUE_SECTION_P (@var{decl})
|
|
|
|
A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{decl} should be placed
|
|
|
|
into a unique section for some target-specific reason. If you do not
|
|
|
|
define this macro, the default is @samp{0}. Note that the flag
|
|
|
|
@samp{-ffunction-sections} will also cause functions to be placed into
|
|
|
|
unique sections.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex UNIQUE_SECTION
|
|
|
|
@item UNIQUE_SECTION (@var{decl}, @var{reloc})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to build up a unique section name, expressed as a
|
|
|
|
STRING_CST node, and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
|
|
|
|
@var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp} requires
|
|
|
|
link-time relocations. If you do not define this macro, GNU CC will use
|
|
|
|
the symbol name prefixed by @samp{.} as the section name.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node PIC
|
|
|
|
@section Position Independent Code
|
|
|
|
@cindex position independent code
|
|
|
|
@cindex PIC
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
|
|
|
|
independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
|
|
|
|
generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the macros
|
|
|
|
@code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as
|
|
|
|
well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You must modify the definition of
|
|
|
|
@samp{movsi} to do something appropriate when the source operand
|
|
|
|
contains a symbolic address. You may also need to alter the handling of
|
|
|
|
switch statements so that they use relative addresses.
|
|
|
|
@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
@item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
The register number of the register used to address a table of static
|
|
|
|
data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
|
|
|
|
processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI). When this macro
|
|
|
|
is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
|
|
|
|
pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
|
|
|
|
is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
|
|
|
|
necessary).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
|
|
|
|
@item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the register defined by
|
|
|
|
@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. Do not define
|
|
|
|
this macro if @code{PPIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FINALIZE_PIC
|
|
|
|
@item FINALIZE_PIC
|
|
|
|
By generating position-independent code, when two different programs (A
|
|
|
|
and B) share a common library (libC.a), the text of the library can be
|
|
|
|
shared whether or not the library is linked at the same address for both
|
|
|
|
programs. In some of these environments, position-independent code
|
|
|
|
requires not only the use of different addressing modes, but also
|
|
|
|
special code to enable the use of these addressing modes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The @code{FINALIZE_PIC} macro serves as a hook to emit these special
|
|
|
|
codes once the function is being compiled into assembly code, but not
|
|
|
|
before. (It is not done before, because in the case of compiling an
|
|
|
|
inline function, it would lead to multiple PIC prologues being
|
|
|
|
included in functions which used inline functions and were compiled to
|
|
|
|
assembly language.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P
|
|
|
|
@item LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
|
|
|
|
operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
|
|
|
|
You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
|
|
|
|
check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
|
|
|
|
(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
position independent code.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Assembler Format
|
|
|
|
@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
|
|
|
|
to write instructions in assembler language--rather than what the
|
|
|
|
instructions do.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
|
|
* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
|
|
|
|
* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
|
|
|
|
* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
|
|
|
|
* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
|
|
|
|
* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
|
|
|
|
and termination routines.
|
|
|
|
* Macros for Initialization::
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Specific macros that control the handling of
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
initialization and termination routines.
|
|
|
|
* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
|
|
|
|
* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
|
|
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node File Framework
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@cindex assembler format
|
|
|
|
@cindex output of assembler code
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
This describes the overall framework of an assembler file.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_FILE_START
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_FILE_START (@var{stream})
|
|
|
|
A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
|
|
|
|
some appropriate text to go at the start of an assembler file.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Normally this macro is defined to output a line containing
|
|
|
|
@samp{#NO_APP}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
|
|
|
|
assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it can save time by not
|
|
|
|
checking for certain assembler constructs.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
|
|
|
|
see @file{attasm.h}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_FILE_END
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_FILE_END (@var{stream})
|
|
|
|
A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
|
|
|
|
some appropriate text to go at the end of an assembler file.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, the default is to output nothing
|
|
|
|
special at the end of the file. Most systems don't require any
|
|
|
|
definition.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
|
|
|
|
see @file{attasm.h}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_IDENTIFY_GCC
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_IDENTIFY_GCC (@var{file})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output assembler commands which will identify
|
|
|
|
the object file as having been compiled with GNU CC (or another
|
|
|
|
GNU compiler).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this macro, the string @samp{gcc_compiled.:}
|
|
|
|
is output. This string is calculated to define a symbol which,
|
|
|
|
on BSD systems, will never be defined for any other reason.
|
|
|
|
GDB checks for the presence of this symbol when reading the
|
|
|
|
symbol table of an executable.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On non-BSD systems, you must arrange communication with GDB in
|
|
|
|
some other fashion. If GDB is not used on your system, you can
|
|
|
|
define this macro with an empty body.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_COMMENT_START
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_COMMENT_START
|
|
|
|
A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
|
|
|
|
assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
|
|
|
|
the end of the line.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_APP_ON
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_APP_ON
|
|
|
|
A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
|
|
|
|
statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
|
|
|
|
@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
|
|
|
|
assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
|
|
|
|
that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_APP_OFF
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_APP_OFF
|
|
|
|
A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
|
|
|
|
statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
|
|
|
|
@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
|
|
|
|
time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
|
|
|
|
which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
|
|
|
|
the stdio stream @var{stream}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
|
|
|
|
for the file format in use is appropriate.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING
|
|
|
|
@item OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
|
|
|
|
in your config files, GNU CC will only call it to output filenames to
|
|
|
|
the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
|
|
|
|
of the filename using this macro.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output DBX or SDB debugging information before code
|
|
|
|
for line number @var{line} of the current source file to the
|
|
|
|
stdio stream @var{stream}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not be defined if the standard form of debugging
|
|
|
|
information for the debugger in use is appropriate.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
|
|
|
|
@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
|
|
|
|
macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SECTION_NAME
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_SECTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{reloc})
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
A C statement to output something to the assembler file to switch to section
|
|
|
|
@var{name} for object @var{decl} which is either a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, a
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{VAR_DECL} or @code{NULL_TREE}. @var{reloc}
|
|
|
|
indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time
|
|
|
|
relocations. Some target formats do not support
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
arbitrary sections. Do not define this macro in such cases.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
At present this macro is only used to support section attributes.
|
|
|
|
When this macro is undefined, section attributes are disabled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex OBJC_PROLOGUE
|
|
|
|
@item OBJC_PROLOGUE
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output any assembler statements which are required to
|
|
|
|
precede any Objective C object definitions or message sending. The
|
|
|
|
statement is executed only when compiling an Objective C program.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@need 2000
|
|
|
|
@node Data Output
|
|
|
|
@subsection Output of Data
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
This describes data output.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LONG_DOUBLE
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_FLOAT
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{stream}, @var{value})
|
|
|
|
@itemx ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE (@var{stream}, @var{value})
|
|
|
|
@itemx ASM_OUTPUT_FLOAT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
|
|
|
|
@itemx ASM_OUTPUT_THREE_QUARTER_FLOAT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
|
|
|
|
@itemx ASM_OUTPUT_SHORT_FLOAT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
|
|
|
|
@itemx ASM_OUTPUT_BYTE_FLOAT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
|
|
|
|
instruction to assemble a floating-point constant of @code{TFmode},
|
|
|
|
@code{DFmode}, @code{SFmode}, @code{TQFmode}, @code{HFmode}, or
|
|
|
|
@code{QFmode}, respectively, whose value is @var{value}. @var{value}
|
|
|
|
will be a C expression of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}. Macros such as
|
|
|
|
@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE} are useful for writing these
|
|
|
|
definitions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_QUADRUPLE_INT
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE_INT
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_INT
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHORT
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_CHAR
|
|
|
|
@findex output_addr_const
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_QUADRUPLE_INT (@var{stream}, @var{exp})
|
|
|
|
@itemx ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE_INT (@var{stream}, @var{exp})
|
|
|
|
@itemx ASM_OUTPUT_INT (@var{stream}, @var{exp})
|
|
|
|
@itemx ASM_OUTPUT_SHORT (@var{stream}, @var{exp})
|
|
|
|
@itemx ASM_OUTPUT_CHAR (@var{stream}, @var{exp})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
|
|
|
|
instruction to assemble an integer of 16, 8, 4, 2 or 1 bytes,
|
|
|
|
respectively, whose value is @var{value}. The argument @var{exp} will
|
|
|
|
be an RTL expression which represents a constant value. Use
|
|
|
|
@samp{output_addr_const (@var{stream}, @var{exp})} to output this value
|
|
|
|
as an assembler expression.@refill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For sizes larger than @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}, if the action of a macro
|
|
|
|
would be identical to repeatedly calling the macro corresponding to
|
|
|
|
a size of @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}, once for each word, you need not define
|
|
|
|
the macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_BYTE
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_BYTE (@var{stream}, @var{value})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
|
|
|
|
instruction to assemble a single byte containing the number @var{value}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_BYTE_OP
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_BYTE_OP
|
|
|
|
A C string constant giving the pseudo-op to use for a sequence of
|
|
|
|
single-byte constants. If this macro is not defined, the default is
|
|
|
|
@code{"byte"}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
|
|
|
|
instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
|
|
|
|
bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
|
|
|
|
@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
|
|
|
|
Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
|
|
|
|
@item CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
|
|
|
|
You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
|
|
|
|
expression to have a non-zero value if GNU CC should output the constant
|
|
|
|
pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
|
|
|
|
GNU CC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
|
|
|
|
not define this macro, the usual case, GNU CC will output the constant
|
|
|
|
pool before the function.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
|
|
|
|
constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
|
|
|
|
the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
|
|
|
|
be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
|
|
|
|
is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
|
|
|
|
immediately after this call.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
|
|
|
|
not be defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
|
|
|
|
constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
|
|
|
|
anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
|
|
|
|
assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
|
|
|
|
output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
|
|
|
|
@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
|
|
|
|
@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
|
|
|
|
alignment.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
|
|
|
|
the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
|
|
|
|
responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
|
|
|
|
Here is how to do this:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
|
|
|
|
@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
|
|
|
|
entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P
|
|
|
|
@item CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P (@var{exp})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if the constant
|
|
|
|
@var{exp}, of type @code{tree}, should be output after the code for a
|
|
|
|
function. The compiler will normally output all constants before the
|
|
|
|
function; you need not define this macro if this is OK.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
|
|
|
|
pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
|
|
|
|
function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
|
|
|
|
obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
|
|
|
|
constant pool that GNU CC wrote immediately before this call.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
|
|
|
|
define this macro.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR
|
|
|
|
@item IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
|
|
|
|
used as a logical line separator by the assembler.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
|
|
|
|
the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OPEN_PAREN
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OPEN_PAREN
|
|
|
|
@itemx ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
|
|
|
|
These macros are defined as C string constant, describing the syntax
|
|
|
|
in the assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. The following
|
|
|
|
definitions are correct for most assemblers:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
#define ASM_OPEN_PAREN "("
|
|
|
|
#define ASM_CLOSE_PAREN ")"
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
|
|
|
|
of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
|
|
|
|
@itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
|
|
|
|
@itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE
|
|
|
|
These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the target's
|
|
|
|
floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in the array of
|
|
|
|
@code{long int} whose address is @var{l}. The number of elements in the
|
|
|
|
output array is determined by the size of the desired target floating
|
|
|
|
point data type: 32 bits of it go in each @code{long int} array
|
|
|
|
element. Each array element holds 32 bits of the result, even if
|
|
|
|
@code{long int} is wider than 32 bits on the host machine.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
|
|
|
|
using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
|
|
|
|
machine's memory.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_TO_DECIMAL (@var{x}, @var{format}, @var{string})
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_DECIMAL
|
|
|
|
This macro converts @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to a
|
|
|
|
decimal number and stores it as a string into @var{string}.
|
|
|
|
You must pass, as @var{string}, the address of a long enough block
|
|
|
|
of space to hold the result.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The argument @var{format} is a @code{printf}-specification that serves
|
|
|
|
as a suggestion for how to format the output string.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Uninitialized Data
|
|
|
|
@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
|
|
|
|
outputting a single uninitialized variable.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
|
|
|
|
@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
|
|
|
|
is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
|
|
|
|
output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
|
|
|
|
assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
common global variables are output.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
|
|
|
|
Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
|
|
|
|
separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
|
|
|
|
place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
|
|
|
|
handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
|
|
|
|
as the number of bits.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
|
|
|
|
Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
|
|
|
|
variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
|
|
|
|
is not corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GNU CC wil use it
|
|
|
|
in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
|
|
|
|
the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
|
|
|
|
If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, except that it
|
|
|
|
is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
|
|
|
|
will be used.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_BSS
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
|
|
|
|
@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
|
|
|
|
is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
|
|
|
|
defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
|
|
|
|
@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
|
|
|
|
before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
|
|
|
|
the name, and a newline.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized global
|
|
|
|
variables are output. This macro exists to properly support languages like
|
|
|
|
@code{c++} which do not have @code{common} data. However, this macro currently
|
|
|
|
is not defined for all targets. If this macro and
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are not defined then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
|
|
|
|
or @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} or
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON} is used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
|
|
|
|
Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
|
|
|
|
separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
|
|
|
|
place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
|
|
|
|
handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
|
|
|
|
as the number of bits.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
|
|
|
|
@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
|
|
|
|
If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, except that it
|
|
|
|
is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}
|
|
|
|
will be used.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
|
|
|
|
@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
|
|
|
|
is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
|
|
|
|
output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
|
|
|
|
assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
|
|
|
|
static variables are output.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
|
|
|
|
Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
|
|
|
|
separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
|
|
|
|
place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
|
|
|
|
handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
|
|
|
|
as the number of bits.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
|
|
|
|
Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
|
|
|
|
variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
|
|
|
|
is not corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GNU CC wil use it
|
|
|
|
in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
|
|
|
|
the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
|
|
|
|
If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, except that it
|
|
|
|
is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}
|
|
|
|
will be used.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Label Output
|
|
|
|
@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
This is about outputting labels.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL
|
|
|
|
@findex assemble_name
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
|
|
|
|
Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
|
|
|
|
output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
|
|
|
|
assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
|
|
|
|
function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
|
|
|
|
outputting the label definition (perhaps using
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
|
|
|
|
usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
|
|
|
|
which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
|
|
|
|
function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
|
|
|
|
representing the function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
|
|
|
|
initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
|
|
|
|
label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
|
|
|
|
@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
|
|
|
|
usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
|
|
|
|
once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
|
|
|
|
chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
|
|
|
|
initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
|
|
|
|
something about the size of the object.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
|
|
|
|
nothing.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
|
|
|
|
that is, available for reference from other files. Use the expression
|
|
|
|
@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
|
|
|
|
itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
|
|
|
|
for making that name global, and a newline.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
|
|
|
|
that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
|
|
|
|
no other definition is available. Use the expression
|
|
|
|
@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
|
|
|
|
itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
|
|
|
|
for making that name weak, and a newline.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this macro, GNU CC will not support weak
|
|
|
|
symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SUPPORTS_WEAK
|
|
|
|
@item SUPPORTS_WEAK
|
|
|
|
A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
|
|
|
|
definition. If @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} is defined, the default
|
|
|
|
definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
|
|
|
|
you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler flag such as
|
|
|
|
@samp{-melf}.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
|
|
|
|
@item MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
|
|
|
|
public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
|
|
|
|
be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
|
|
|
|
format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
|
|
|
|
section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
|
|
|
|
requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
|
|
|
|
@item SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
|
|
|
|
A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
|
|
|
|
semantics.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
|
|
|
|
definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
|
|
|
|
definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
|
|
|
|
you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
|
|
|
|
setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
|
|
|
|
be emitted as one-only.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
|
|
|
|
symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
|
|
|
|
not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
|
|
|
|
declaration.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
|
|
|
|
The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (@var{stream}, @var{symref})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output on @var{stream} an assembler
|
|
|
|
pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
|
|
|
|
library function is given by @var{symref}, which has type @code{rtx} and
|
|
|
|
is a @code{symbol_ref}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
|
|
|
|
The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
|
|
|
A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
|
|
|
|
@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
|
|
|
|
is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
|
|
|
|
systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@ignore @c Seems not to exist anymore.
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF_AS_INT
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF_AS_INT (@var{file}, @var{label})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro for systems that use the program @code{collect2}.
|
|
|
|
The definition should be a C statement to output a word containing
|
|
|
|
a reference to the label @var{label}.
|
|
|
|
@end ignore
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
|
|
|
|
name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
|
|
|
|
used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
|
|
|
|
will have name conflicts with internal labels.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
|
|
|
|
object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
|
|
|
|
should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
|
|
|
|
beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
|
|
|
|
convention your system uses, and follow it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The usual definition of this macro is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
fprintf (@var{stream}, "L%s%d:\n", @var{prefix}, @var{num})
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
|
|
|
|
is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
|
|
|
|
produce the output that @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL} would produce
|
|
|
|
with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
|
|
|
|
output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
|
|
|
|
string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
|
|
|
|
to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
|
|
|
|
you should know what it does on your machine.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
|
|
|
|
A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
|
|
|
|
@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
|
|
|
|
@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
|
|
|
|
added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
|
|
|
|
produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
|
|
|
|
@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
|
|
|
|
assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
|
|
|
|
macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
|
|
|
|
internal static variables in different scopes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
|
|
|
|
conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
|
|
|
|
or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
|
|
|
|
between the name and the number will suffice.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
|
|
|
|
which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If SET_ASM_OP is defined, a default definition is provided which is
|
|
|
|
correct for most systems.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEFINE_LABEL_DIFFERENCE_SYMBOL
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_DEFINE_LABEL_DIFFERENCE_SYMBOL (@var{stream}, @var{symbol}, @var{high}, @var{low})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
|
|
|
|
which defines (equates) the symbol @var{symbol} to have a value equal to
|
|
|
|
the difference of the two symbols @var{high} and @var{low}, i.e.
|
|
|
|
@var{high} minus @var{low}. GNU CC guarantees that the symbols @var{high}
|
|
|
|
and @var{low} are already known by the assembler so that the difference
|
|
|
|
resolves into a constant.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If SET_ASM_OP is defined, a default definition is provided which is
|
|
|
|
correct for most systems.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
|
|
|
|
which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
|
|
|
|
@var{value}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
|
|
|
|
ASM_OUTPUT_DEF instead if possible.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL
|
|
|
|
@item OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
|
|
|
|
Objective C methods.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
|
|
|
|
class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
|
|
|
|
the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
|
|
|
|
@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
|
|
|
|
the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
|
|
|
|
systems define other ways of computing names.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
|
|
|
|
buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
|
|
|
|
@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
|
|
|
|
50 characters extra.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
|
|
|
|
method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
|
|
|
|
@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or NULL if the method is not
|
|
|
|
in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
|
|
|
|
macro to provide more human-readable names.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Initialization
|
|
|
|
@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
|
|
|
|
@cindex initialization routines
|
|
|
|
@cindex termination routines
|
|
|
|
@cindex constructors, output of
|
|
|
|
@cindex destructors, output of
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
|
|
|
|
(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
|
|
|
|
data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
|
|
|
|
to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
|
|
|
|
@code{main} is called.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
|
|
|
|
@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
|
|
|
|
terminates.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
|
|
|
|
must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
|
|
|
|
be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
|
|
|
|
system, you need to specify how to do this.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
|
|
|
|
initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
|
|
|
|
Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex __CTOR_LIST__
|
|
|
|
@findex __DTOR_LIST__
|
|
|
|
The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
|
|
|
|
initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
|
|
|
|
termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
|
|
|
|
0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
|
|
|
|
the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
|
|
|
|
pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
|
|
|
|
pointer containing zero.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
|
|
|
|
@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
|
|
|
|
time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
|
|
|
|
list; destructors in forward order.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
|
|
|
|
formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
|
|
|
|
aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
|
|
|
|
Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
|
|
|
|
object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
|
|
|
|
the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
|
|
|
|
accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
|
|
|
|
Termination functions are handled similarly.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To use this method, you need appropriate definitions of the macros
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DESTRUCTOR}. Usually
|
|
|
|
you can get them by including @file{svr4.h}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
|
|
|
|
upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
|
|
|
|
support an @dfn{init} section which is executed at program startup,
|
|
|
|
parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
|
|
|
|
program is linked by the @code{gcc} driver like this:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
ld -o @var{output_file} crtbegin.o @dots{} crtend.o -lgcc
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The head of a function (@code{__do_global_ctors}) appears in the init
|
|
|
|
section of @file{crtbegin.o}; the remainder of the function appears in
|
|
|
|
the init section of @file{crtend.o}. The linker will pull these two
|
|
|
|
parts of the section together, making a whole function. If any of the
|
|
|
|
user's object files linked into the middle of it contribute code, then that
|
|
|
|
code will be executed as part of the body of @code{__do_global_ctors}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
|
|
|
|
macro properly.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If no init section is available, do not define
|
|
|
|
@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. Then @code{__do_global_ctors} is built into
|
|
|
|
the text section like all other functions, and resides in
|
|
|
|
@file{libgcc.a}. When GCC compiles any function called @code{main}, it
|
|
|
|
inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
|
|
|
|
after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function, also defined
|
|
|
|
in @file{libgcc2.c}, simply calls @file{__do_global_ctors}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
|
|
|
|
two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
|
|
|
|
and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
|
|
|
|
entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
|
|
|
|
and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
|
|
|
|
code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
|
|
|
|
the value to a ``set''; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
|
|
|
|
placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
|
|
|
|
a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
|
|
|
|
section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
|
|
|
|
the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
|
|
|
|
the initialization process.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
|
|
|
|
This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
|
|
|
|
file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'. In
|
|
|
|
this case, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR} does not produce an
|
|
|
|
@code{N_SETT} symbol; initialization and termination functions are
|
|
|
|
recognized simply by their names. This requires an extra program in the
|
|
|
|
linkage step, called @code{collect2}. This program pretends to be the
|
|
|
|
linker, for use with GNU CC; it does its job by running the ordinary
|
|
|
|
linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of initialization and
|
|
|
|
termination functions. These functions are called via @code{__main} as
|
|
|
|
described above.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Choosing among these configuration options has been simplified by a set
|
|
|
|
of operating-system-dependent files in the @file{config} subdirectory.
|
|
|
|
These files define all of the relevant parameters. Usually it is
|
|
|
|
sufficient to include one into your specific machine-dependent
|
|
|
|
configuration file. These files are:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @file
|
|
|
|
@item aoutos.h
|
|
|
|
For operating systems using the `a.out' format.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item next.h
|
|
|
|
For operating systems using the `MachO' format.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item svr3.h
|
|
|
|
For System V Release 3 and similar systems using `COFF' format.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item svr4.h
|
|
|
|
For System V Release 4 and similar systems using `ELF' format.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item vms.h
|
|
|
|
For the VMS operating system.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@ifinfo
|
|
|
|
The following section describes the specific macros that control and
|
|
|
|
customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
|
|
|
|
@end ifinfo
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Macros for Initialization
|
|
|
|
@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
|
|
|
|
and termination functions:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
|
|
|
@item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C string constant for the assembler operation to identify
|
|
|
|
the following data as initialization code. If not defined, GNU CC will
|
|
|
|
assume such a section does not exist. When you are using special
|
|
|
|
sections for initialization and termination functions, this macro also
|
|
|
|
controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to run the
|
|
|
|
initialization functions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item HAS_INIT_SECTION
|
|
|
|
@findex HAS_INIT_SECTION
|
|
|
|
If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
|
|
|
|
This macro should be defined for systems that control the contents of the
|
|
|
|
init section on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
|
|
|
|
be defined explicitly for systems that support
|
|
|
|
@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item LD_INIT_SWITCH
|
|
|
|
@findex LD_INIT_SWITCH
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
|
|
|
|
the following symbol is an initialization routine.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item LD_FINI_SWITCH
|
|
|
|
@findex LD_FINI_SWITCH
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
|
|
|
|
the following symbol is a finalization routine.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item INVOKE__main
|
|
|
|
@findex INVOKE__main
|
|
|
|
If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
|
|
|
|
@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
|
|
|
|
where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
|
|
|
|
useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C statement to output on the stream @var{stream}
|
|
|
|
the assembler code to arrange to call the function named @var{name} at
|
|
|
|
initialization time.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Assume that @var{name} is the name of a C function generated
|
|
|
|
automatically by the compiler. This function takes no arguments. Use
|
|
|
|
the function @code{assemble_name} to output the name @var{name}; this
|
|
|
|
performs any system-specific syntactic transformations such as adding an
|
|
|
|
underscore.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output to arrange to
|
|
|
|
call the function. This is correct when the function will be called in
|
|
|
|
some other manner---for example, by means of the @code{collect2} program,
|
|
|
|
which looks through the symbol table to find these functions by their
|
|
|
|
names.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_DESTRUCTOR (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DESTRUCTOR
|
|
|
|
This is like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
|
|
|
|
functions rather than initialization functions.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When @code{ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DESTRUCTOR} are
|
|
|
|
defined, the initializaiton routine generated for the generated object
|
|
|
|
file will have static linkage.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If your system uses @code{collect2} as the means of processing
|
|
|
|
constructors, then that program normally uses @code{nm} to scan an
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
object file for constructor functions to be called. On such systems you
|
|
|
|
must not define @code{ASM_OUTPUT_CONSTRUCTOR} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DESTRUCTOR}
|
|
|
|
as the object file's initialization routine must have global scope.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On certain kinds of systems, you can define these macros to make
|
|
|
|
@code{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
|
|
|
|
@item OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
|
|
|
|
object files, so that @code{collect2} can assume this format and scan
|
|
|
|
object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
|
|
|
|
@item OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the system uses ROSE format object files, so that
|
|
|
|
@code{collect2} can assume this format and scan object files directly
|
|
|
|
for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
These macros are effective only in a native compiler; @code{collect2} as
|
|
|
|
part of a cross compiler always uses @code{nm} for the target machine.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
|
|
|
|
to execute @code{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
|
|
|
|
@code{nm}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
|
|
|
|
dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
|
|
|
|
these macros to enable support for running initialization and
|
|
|
|
termination functions in shared libraries:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LDD_SUFFIX
|
|
|
|
@item LDD_SUFFIX
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the
|
|
|
|
program which lists dynamic dependencies, like @code{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT
|
|
|
|
@item PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{PTR})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
|
|
|
|
of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{PTR} is a variable
|
|
|
|
of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
|
|
|
|
from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
|
|
|
|
code must advance @var{PTR} to the beginning of the filename on that
|
|
|
|
line. Otherwise, it must set @var{PTR} to @code{NULL}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Instruction Output
|
|
|
|
@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
This describes assembler instruction output.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex REGISTER_NAMES
|
|
|
|
@item REGISTER_NAMES
|
|
|
|
A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
|
|
|
|
registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
|
|
|
|
register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
|
|
|
|
@item ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
|
|
|
|
and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
|
|
|
|
registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
|
|
|
|
to registers using alternate names.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
|
|
|
|
requires different names for the machine instructions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
|
|
|
|
assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
|
|
|
|
macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
|
|
|
|
points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
|
|
|
|
written in the machine description. The definition should output the
|
|
|
|
opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
|
|
|
|
increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
|
|
|
|
so that it will not be output twice.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
|
|
|
|
name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
|
|
|
|
that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
|
|
|
|
care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
|
|
|
|
@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex recog_operand
|
|
|
|
If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
|
|
|
|
elements of @code{recog_operand}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
|
|
|
|
in the usual way.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN
|
|
|
|
@item FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
|
|
|
|
assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
|
|
|
|
they will be output differently.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
|
|
|
|
extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
|
|
|
|
elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
|
|
|
|
The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
|
|
|
|
template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
|
|
|
|
by changing the contents of the vector.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
|
|
|
|
file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
|
|
|
|
can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
|
|
|
|
as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
|
|
|
|
syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
|
|
|
|
writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
|
|
|
|
@item FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
|
|
|
|
If defined, @code{FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN} will be called on each
|
|
|
|
@code{CODE_LABEL}. In that case, @var{opvec} will be a null pointer and
|
|
|
|
@var{noperands} will be zero.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex PRINT_OPERAND
|
|
|
|
@item PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
|
|
|
|
A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
|
|
|
|
assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
|
|
|
|
RTL expression.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
|
|
|
|
of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
|
|
|
|
printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
|
|
|
|
the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
|
|
|
|
operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
|
|
|
|
@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
|
|
|
|
@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex reg_names
|
|
|
|
If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
|
|
|
|
The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
|
|
|
|
@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
|
|
|
|
@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
|
|
|
|
(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
|
|
|
|
with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
|
|
|
|
@var{code}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P
|
|
|
|
@item PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
|
|
|
|
A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
|
|
|
|
punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
|
|
|
|
@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
|
|
|
|
punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
|
|
|
|
in this way.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS
|
|
|
|
@item PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
|
|
|
|
A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
|
|
|
|
assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
|
|
|
|
whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
|
|
|
|
On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
|
|
|
|
section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the macro
|
|
|
|
@code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
|
|
|
|
@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler Format}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND
|
|
|
|
@findex dbr_sequence_length
|
|
|
|
@item DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND(@var{file})
|
|
|
|
A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
|
|
|
|
been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
|
|
|
|
determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
|
|
|
|
currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
|
|
|
|
or whatever.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
|
|
|
|
reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
|
|
|
|
explicit (e.g. with white space).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex final_sequence
|
|
|
|
Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
|
|
|
|
prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence (i.e.
|
|
|
|
when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
|
|
|
|
found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
|
|
|
|
processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
|
|
|
|
being output.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REGISTER_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
@findex LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
@findex USER_LABEL_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
@findex IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
@findex asm_fprintf
|
|
|
|
@item REGISTER_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
@itemx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
@itemx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
@itemx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
|
|
|
|
If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
|
|
|
|
@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
|
|
|
|
@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
|
|
|
|
support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
|
|
|
|
files can define these macros differently.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
|
|
|
|
@item ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
|
|
|
|
If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
|
|
|
|
different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
|
|
|
|
numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
|
|
|
|
first variant.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
|
|
|
|
@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}} in the output
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the first argument
|
|
|
|
of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs @samp{option0},
|
|
|
|
@samp{option1} or @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
|
|
|
|
@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one or two, etc. Any special
|
|
|
|
characters within these strings retain their usual meaning.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
|
|
|
|
@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
|
|
|
|
operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
|
|
|
|
@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
|
|
|
|
if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
|
|
|
|
opcodes or operand order.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
|
|
|
|
A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
|
|
|
|
which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
|
|
|
|
The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
|
|
|
|
profiling.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
|
|
|
|
A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
|
|
|
|
which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
|
|
|
|
The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
|
|
|
|
profiling.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Dispatch Tables
|
|
|
|
@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
This concerns dispatch tables.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@cindex dispatch table
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
|
|
|
|
pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
|
|
|
|
@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
|
|
|
|
definitions of these labels are output using
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}, and they must be printed in the same
|
|
|
|
way here. For example,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
|
|
|
|
@var{value}, @var{rel})
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
|
|
|
|
dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GNU
|
|
|
|
CC will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC.
|
|
|
|
@var{body} is the body of the ADDR_DIFF_VEC; it is provided so that the
|
|
|
|
mode and flags can be read.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
|
|
|
|
This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
|
|
|
|
in a dispatch table are absolute.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
|
|
|
|
a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
|
|
|
|
definition is output using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
|
|
|
|
For example,
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|
|
fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
|
|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
|
|
|
|
Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
|
|
|
|
specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}; the fourth argument is the
|
|
|
|
jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
|
|
|
|
@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
|
|
|
|
for the table.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
|
|
|
|
@code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
|
|
|
|
Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
|
|
|
|
jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
|
|
|
|
after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
|
|
|
|
the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
|
|
|
|
@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
|
|
|
|
of the preceding label.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
|
|
|
|
the jump-table.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@node Exception Region Output
|
|
|
|
@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
|
|
|
|
region.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_EH_REGION_BEG
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_EH_REGION_BEG ()
|
|
|
|
A C expression to output text to mark the start of an exception region.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not be defined on most platforms.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_EH_REGION_END
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_EH_REGION_END ()
|
|
|
|
A C expression to output text to mark the end of an exception region.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not be defined on most platforms.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex EXCEPTION_SECTION
|
|
|
|
@item EXCEPTION_SECTION ()
|
|
|
|
A C expression to switch to the section in which the main
|
|
|
|
exception table is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}). The default is a
|
|
|
|
section named @code{.gcc_except_table} on machines that support named
|
|
|
|
sections via @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SECTION_NAME}, otherwise if @samp{-fpic}
|
|
|
|
or @samp{-fPIC} is in effect, the @code{data_section}, otherwise the
|
|
|
|
@code{readonly_data_section}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex EH_FRAME_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
|
|
|
@item EH_FRAME_SECTION_ASM_OP
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C string constant for the assembler operation to switch to
|
|
|
|
the section for exception handling frame unwind information. If not
|
|
|
|
defined, GNU CC will provide a default definition if the target supports
|
|
|
|
named sections. @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the
|
|
|
|
appropriate section.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
|
|
|
|
unwind information and the default definition does not work.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex OMIT_EH_TABLE
|
|
|
|
@item OMIT_EH_TABLE ()
|
|
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if the normal exception table output
|
|
|
|
should be omitted.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not be defined on most platforms.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex EH_TABLE_LOOKUP
|
|
|
|
@item EH_TABLE_LOOKUP ()
|
|
|
|
Alternate runtime support for looking up an exception at runtime and
|
|
|
|
finding the associated handler, if the default method won't work.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not be defined on most platforms.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DOESNT_NEED_UNWINDER
|
|
|
|
@item DOESNT_NEED_UNWINDER
|
|
|
|
A C expression that decides whether or not the current function needs to
|
|
|
|
have a function unwinder generated for it. See the file @code{except.c}
|
|
|
|
for details on when to define this, and how.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MASK_RETURN_ADDR
|
|
|
|
@item MASK_RETURN_ADDR
|
|
|
|
An rtx used to mask the return address found via RETURN_ADDR_RTX, so
|
|
|
|
that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
|
|
|
|
@item DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
|
|
|
|
information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
|
|
|
|
Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
|
|
|
|
@samp{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @samp{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
|
|
|
|
or @samp{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of
|
|
|
|
1.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is defined to 1, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be the default
|
|
|
|
exception handling mechanism; otherwise, setjmp/longjmp will be used by
|
|
|
|
default.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If this macro is defined to anything, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be used
|
|
|
|
instead of inline unwinders and __unwind_function in the non-setjmp case.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@node Alignment Output
|
|
|
|
@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
This describes commands for alignment.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER
|
|
|
|
@item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
|
|
|
|
The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
|
|
|
|
a BARRIER.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
|
|
|
|
to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
|
|
|
|
define the macro.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex LOOP_ALIGN
|
|
|
|
@item LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
|
|
|
|
The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
|
|
|
|
a NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG note.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
|
|
|
|
to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
|
|
|
|
define the macro.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex LABEL_ALIGN
|
|
|
|
@item LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
|
|
|
|
The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
|
|
|
|
If LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER / LOOP_ALIGN specify a different alignment,
|
|
|
|
the maximum of the specified values is used.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
|
|
|
|
instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
|
|
|
|
Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
|
|
|
|
expression of type @code{int}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
|
|
|
|
produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
|
|
|
|
section.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
|
|
|
|
command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
|
|
|
|
@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@need 3000
|
|
|
|
@node Debugging Info
|
|
|
|
@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
This describes how to specify debugging information.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
|
|
* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
|
|
|
|
* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
|
|
|
|
* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
|
|
|
|
* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
|
|
|
|
* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
|
|
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node All Debuggers
|
|
|
|
@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
These macros affect all debugging formats.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
|
|
|
|
register number @var{regno}. In simple cases, the value of this
|
|
|
|
expression may be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are some
|
|
|
|
registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
|
|
|
|
versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in
|
|
|
|
the compiler and another for DBX.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GNU CC, and they can be
|
|
|
|
used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
|
|
|
|
consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
|
|
|
|
Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
|
|
|
|
expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
|
|
|
|
does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
|
|
|
|
redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET
|
|
|
|
@item DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
|
|
|
|
variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
|
|
|
|
computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
|
|
|
|
gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
|
|
|
|
that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
|
|
|
|
for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
|
|
|
|
@samp{-g} options is used.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET
|
|
|
|
@item DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
|
|
|
|
A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
|
|
|
|
having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
|
|
|
|
@var{offset}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
|
|
|
|
@item PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GNU CC should
|
|
|
|
produce when the user specifies just @samp{-g}. Define
|
|
|
|
this if you have arranged for GNU CC to support more than one format of
|
|
|
|
debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
|
|
|
|
@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}, and
|
|
|
|
@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
When the user specifies @samp{-ggdb}, GNU CC normally also uses the
|
|
|
|
value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
|
|
|
|
exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined and
|
|
|
|
@code{LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2} is not defined, GNU CC uses the
|
|
|
|
value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
|
|
|
|
defined, GNU CC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
|
|
|
|
user can always get a specific type of output by using @samp{-gstabs},
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@samp{-gcoff}, @samp{-gdwarf-1}, @samp{-gdwarf-2}, or @samp{-gxcoff}.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node DBX Options
|
|
|
|
@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
These are specific options for DBX output.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if GNU CC should produce debugging output for DBX
|
|
|
|
in response to the @samp{-g} option.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
|
|
|
@item XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if GNU CC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
|
|
|
|
in response to the @samp{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
|
|
|
|
@item DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to control whether GNU CC should by default generate
|
|
|
|
GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
|
|
|
|
debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
|
|
|
|
macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
|
|
|
|
if there is any occasion to.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
|
|
|
|
@item DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
|
|
|
|
in the text section.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_STABS_OP
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_STABS_OP
|
|
|
|
A C string constant naming the assembler pseudo op to use instead of
|
|
|
|
@code{.stabs} to define an ordinary debugging symbol. If you don't
|
|
|
|
define this macro, @code{.stabs} is used. This macro applies only to
|
|
|
|
DBX debugging information format.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_STABD_OP
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_STABD_OP
|
|
|
|
A C string constant naming the assembler pseudo op to use instead of
|
|
|
|
@code{.stabd} to define a debugging symbol whose value is the current
|
|
|
|
location. If you don't define this macro, @code{.stabd} is used.
|
|
|
|
This macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ASM_STABN_OP
|
|
|
|
@item ASM_STABN_OP
|
|
|
|
A C string constant naming the assembler pseudo op to use instead of
|
|
|
|
@code{.stabn} to define a debugging symbol with no name. If you don't
|
|
|
|
define this macro, @code{.stabn} is used. This macro applies only to
|
|
|
|
DBX debugging information format.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_NO_XREFS
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_NO_XREFS
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
|
|
|
|
@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
|
|
|
|
describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
|
|
|
|
On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
|
|
|
|
A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
|
|
|
|
continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
|
|
|
|
exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
|
|
|
|
operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
|
|
|
|
must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
|
|
|
|
with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
|
|
|
|
defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
|
|
|
|
Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
|
|
|
|
the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
|
|
|
|
a different character instead, define this macro as a character
|
|
|
|
constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
|
|
|
|
if backslash is correct for your system.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
|
|
|
|
outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
|
|
|
|
variable.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
|
|
|
|
The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
|
|
|
|
for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
|
|
|
|
The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
|
|
|
|
for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
|
|
|
|
provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
|
|
|
|
The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
|
|
|
|
for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
|
|
|
|
``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
|
|
|
|
The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
|
|
|
|
passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
|
|
|
|
do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
|
|
|
|
The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a stack
|
|
|
|
parameter. The default is @code{'p'}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
|
|
|
|
arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
|
|
|
|
in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
|
|
|
|
code.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol for a block should
|
|
|
|
precede the debugging information for variables and functions defined in
|
|
|
|
that block. Normally, in DBX format, the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol comes
|
|
|
|
first.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the value of a symbol describing the scope of a
|
|
|
|
block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be relative to the start
|
|
|
|
of the enclosing function. Normally, GNU C uses an absolute address.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_USE_BINCL
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_USE_BINCL
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if GNU C should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
|
|
|
|
@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
|
|
|
|
macro also directs GNU C to output a type number as a pair of a file
|
|
|
|
number and a type number within the file. Normally, GNU C does not
|
|
|
|
generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
|
|
|
|
number for a type number.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node DBX Hooks
|
|
|
|
@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
These are hooks for DBX format.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
|
|
|
|
information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
|
|
|
|
argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
|
|
|
|
@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
|
|
|
Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM (@var{stream}, @var{type})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
|
|
|
|
output an enumeration type. The definition should be a C statement
|
|
|
|
(sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information to @var{stream}
|
|
|
|
for the type @var{type}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END (@var{stream}, @var{function})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the target machine requires special output at the
|
|
|
|
end of the debugging information for a function. The definition should
|
|
|
|
be a C statement (sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information
|
|
|
|
to @var{stream}. @var{function} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} node for
|
|
|
|
the function.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES (@var{syms})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if you need to control the order of output of the
|
|
|
|
standard data types at the beginning of compilation. The argument
|
|
|
|
@var{syms} is a @code{tree} which is a chain of all the predefined
|
|
|
|
global symbols, including names of data types.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Normally, DBX output starts with definitions of the types for integers
|
|
|
|
and characters, followed by all the other predefined types of the
|
|
|
|
particular language in no particular order.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On some machines, it is necessary to output different particular types
|
|
|
|
first. To do this, define @code{DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES} to output
|
|
|
|
those symbols in the necessary order. Any predefined types that you
|
|
|
|
don't explicitly output will be output afterward in no particular order.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Be careful not to define this macro so that it works only for C. There
|
|
|
|
are no global variables to access most of the built-in types, because
|
|
|
|
another language may have another set of types. The way to output a
|
|
|
|
particular type is to look through @var{syms} to see if you can find it.
|
|
|
|
Here is an example:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
@{
|
|
|
|
tree decl;
|
|
|
|
for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
|
|
|
|
if (!strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl)),
|
|
|
|
"long int"))
|
|
|
|
dbxout_symbol (decl);
|
|
|
|
@dots{}
|
|
|
|
@}
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
|
|
This does nothing if the expected type does not exist.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See the function @code{init_decl_processing} in @file{c-decl.c} to find
|
|
|
|
the names to use for all the built-in C types.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Here is another way of finding a particular type:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c this is still overfull. --mew 10feb93
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
@{
|
|
|
|
tree decl;
|
|
|
|
for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL
|
|
|
|
&& (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
|
|
|
|
== INTEGER_CST)
|
|
|
|
&& TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == 16
|
|
|
|
&& TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
|
|
|
|
@group
|
|
|
|
/* @r{This must be @code{unsigned short}.} */
|
|
|
|
dbxout_symbol (decl);
|
|
|
|
@dots{}
|
|
|
|
@}
|
|
|
|
@end group
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
|
|
|
|
@item NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
|
|
|
|
Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
|
|
|
|
@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extention construct.
|
|
|
|
On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
|
|
|
|
disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node File Names and DBX
|
|
|
|
@subsection File Names in DBX Format
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
This describes file names in DBX format.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
|
|
|
|
Define this if DBX wants to have the current directory recorded in each
|
|
|
|
object file.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that the working directory is always recorded if GDB extensions are
|
|
|
|
enabled.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
|
|
|
|
file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
|
|
|
|
This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
|
|
|
|
for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} which indicates that the current directory during
|
|
|
|
compilation is named @var{name}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
|
|
|
|
for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
|
|
|
|
compilation of the main source file @var{name}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
|
|
|
|
of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
|
|
|
|
@item DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
|
|
|
|
A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
|
|
|
|
@var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the current source
|
|
|
|
file. This output is generated each time input shifts to a different
|
|
|
|
source file as a result of @samp{#include}, the end of an included file,
|
|
|
|
or a @samp{#line} command.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
|
|
|
|
for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@need 2000
|
|
|
|
@node SDB and DWARF
|
|
|
|
@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
|
|
|
@item SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if GNU CC should produce COFF-style debugging output
|
|
|
|
for SDB in response to the @samp{-g} option.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
|
|
|
@item DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Define this macro if GNU CC should produce dwarf format debugging output
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
in response to the @samp{-g} option.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
|
|
|
@item DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if GNU CC should produce dwarf version 2 format
|
|
|
|
debugging output in response to the @samp{-g} option.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
|
|
|
|
define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
|
|
|
|
@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
|
|
|
|
prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
|
|
|
|
as appropriate from @code{FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
|
|
|
|
@item DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to a nonzero value if GNU CC should always output
|
|
|
|
Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}
|
|
|
|
(@pxref{Exception Region Output} is nonzero, GNU CC will output this
|
|
|
|
information not matter how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
|
|
|
|
@item LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the linker does not work with Dwarf version 2.
|
|
|
|
Normally, if the user specifies only @samp{-ggdb} GNU CC will use Dwarf
|
|
|
|
version 2 if available; this macro disables this. See the description
|
|
|
|
of the @code{PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE} macro for more details.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex PUT_SDB_@dots{}
|
|
|
|
@item PUT_SDB_@dots{}
|
|
|
|
Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
|
|
|
|
SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
|
|
|
|
macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
|
|
|
|
not define them yourself.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SDB_DELIM
|
|
|
|
@item SDB_DELIM
|
|
|
|
Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
|
|
|
|
SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
|
|
|
|
delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
|
|
|
|
a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
|
|
|
|
required.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
|
|
|
|
@item SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to override the usual method of constructing a dummy
|
|
|
|
name for anonymous structure and union types. See @file{sdbout.c} for
|
|
|
|
more information.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
|
|
|
|
@item SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
|
|
|
|
union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
|
|
|
|
allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
|
|
|
|
it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
|
|
|
|
@item SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
|
|
|
|
enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
|
|
|
|
assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Cross-compilation
|
|
|
|
@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@cindex cross compilation and floating point
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@cindex floating point and cross compilation
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
While all modern machines use 2's complement representation for integers,
|
|
|
|
there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
|
|
|
|
means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
|
|
|
|
in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
|
|
|
|
doing the compilation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex atof
|
|
|
|
Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
|
|
|
|
range and precision, the cross compiler cannot safely use the host
|
|
|
|
machine's floating point arithmetic. Therefore, floating point constants
|
|
|
|
must be represented in the target machine's format. This means that the
|
|
|
|
cross compiler cannot use @code{atof} to parse a floating point constant;
|
|
|
|
it must have its own special routine to use instead. Also, constant
|
|
|
|
folding must emulate the target machine's arithmetic (or must not be done
|
|
|
|
at all).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The macros in the following table should be defined only if you are cross
|
|
|
|
compiling between different floating point formats.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Otherwise, don't define them. Then default definitions will be set up which
|
|
|
|
use @code{double} as the data type, @code{==} to test for equality, etc.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You don't need to worry about how many times you use an operand of any
|
|
|
|
of these macros. The compiler never uses operands which have side effects.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_TYPE
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_TYPE
|
|
|
|
A macro for the C data type to be used to hold a floating point value
|
|
|
|
in the target machine's format. Typically this would be a
|
|
|
|
@code{struct} containing an array of @code{int}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUES_EQUAL
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (@var{x}, @var{y})
|
|
|
|
A macro for a C expression which compares for equality the two values,
|
|
|
|
@var{x} and @var{y}, both of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUES_LESS
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUES_LESS (@var{x}, @var{y})
|
|
|
|
A macro for a C expression which tests whether @var{x} is less than
|
|
|
|
@var{y}, both values being of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} and
|
|
|
|
interpreted as floating point numbers in the target machine's
|
|
|
|
representation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_LDEXP
|
|
|
|
@findex ldexp
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_LDEXP (@var{x}, @var{scale})
|
|
|
|
A macro for a C expression which performs the standard library
|
|
|
|
function @code{ldexp}, but using the target machine's floating point
|
|
|
|
representation. Both @var{x} and the value of the expression have
|
|
|
|
type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}. The second argument, @var{scale}, is an
|
|
|
|
integer.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_FIX
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_FIX (@var{x})
|
|
|
|
A macro whose definition is a C expression to convert the target-machine
|
|
|
|
floating point value @var{x} to a signed integer. @var{x} has type
|
|
|
|
@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (@var{x})
|
|
|
|
A macro whose definition is a C expression to convert the target-machine
|
|
|
|
floating point value @var{x} to an unsigned integer. @var{x} has type
|
|
|
|
@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_RNDZINT
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_RNDZINT (@var{x})
|
|
|
|
A macro whose definition is a C expression to round the target-machine
|
|
|
|
floating point value @var{x} towards zero to an integer value (but still
|
|
|
|
as a floating point number). @var{x} has type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE},
|
|
|
|
and so does the value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_RNDZINT
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_RNDZINT (@var{x})
|
|
|
|
A macro whose definition is a C expression to round the target-machine
|
|
|
|
floating point value @var{x} towards zero to an unsigned integer value
|
|
|
|
(but still represented as a floating point number). @var{x} has type
|
|
|
|
@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, and so does the value.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_ATOF
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_ATOF (@var{string}, @var{mode})
|
|
|
|
A macro for a C expression which converts @var{string}, an expression of
|
|
|
|
type @code{char *}, into a floating point number in the target machine's
|
|
|
|
representation for mode @var{mode}. The value has type
|
|
|
|
@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_INFINITY
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_INFINITY
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if infinity is a possible floating point value, and
|
|
|
|
therefore division by 0 is legitimate.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_ISINF
|
|
|
|
@findex isinf
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_ISINF (@var{x})
|
|
|
|
A macro for a C expression which determines whether @var{x}, a floating
|
|
|
|
point value, is infinity. The value has type @code{int}.
|
|
|
|
By default, this is defined to call @code{isinf}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_ISNAN
|
|
|
|
@findex isnan
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (@var{x})
|
|
|
|
A macro for a C expression which determines whether @var{x}, a floating
|
|
|
|
point value, is a ``nan'' (not-a-number). The value has type
|
|
|
|
@code{int}. By default, this is defined to call @code{isnan}.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex constant folding and floating point
|
|
|
|
Define the following additional macros if you want to make floating
|
|
|
|
point constant folding work while cross compiling. If you don't
|
|
|
|
define them, cross compilation is still possible, but constant folding
|
|
|
|
will not happen for floating point values.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_ARITHMETIC
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_ARITHMETIC (@var{output}, @var{code}, @var{x}, @var{y})
|
|
|
|
A macro for a C statement which calculates an arithmetic operation of
|
|
|
|
the two floating point values @var{x} and @var{y}, both of type
|
|
|
|
@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} in the target machine's representation, to
|
|
|
|
produce a result of the same type and representation which is stored
|
|
|
|
in @var{output} (which will be a variable).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}, a tree code
|
|
|
|
which will always be one of the following: @code{PLUS_EXPR},
|
|
|
|
@code{MINUS_EXPR}, @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR},
|
|
|
|
@code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.@refill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex overflow while constant folding
|
|
|
|
The expansion of this macro is responsible for checking for overflow.
|
|
|
|
If overflow happens, the macro expansion should execute the statement
|
|
|
|
@code{return 0;}, which indicates the inability to perform the
|
|
|
|
arithmetic operation requested.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_NEGATE
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (@var{x})
|
|
|
|
A macro for a C expression which returns the negative of the floating
|
|
|
|
point value @var{x}. Both @var{x} and the value of the expression
|
|
|
|
have type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} and are in the target machine's
|
|
|
|
floating point representation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
There is no way for this macro to report overflow, since overflow
|
|
|
|
can't happen in the negation operation.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (@var{mode}, @var{x})
|
|
|
|
A macro for a C expression which converts the floating point value
|
|
|
|
@var{x} to mode @var{mode}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Both @var{x} and the value of the expression are in the target machine's
|
|
|
|
floating point representation and have type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
|
|
|
|
However, the value should have an appropriate bit pattern to be output
|
|
|
|
properly as a floating constant whose precision accords with mode
|
|
|
|
@var{mode}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
There is no way for this macro to report overflow.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_INT
|
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (@var{low}, @var{high}, @var{x})
|
|
|
|
A macro for a C expression which converts a floating point value
|
|
|
|
@var{x} into a double-precision integer which is then stored into
|
|
|
|
@var{low} and @var{high}, two variables of type @var{int}.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@item REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (@var{x}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{mode})
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT
|
|
|
|
A macro for a C expression which converts a double-precision integer
|
|
|
|
found in @var{low} and @var{high}, two variables of type @var{int},
|
|
|
|
into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
The value is in the target machine's representation for mode @var{mode}
|
|
|
|
and has the type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Misc
|
|
|
|
@section Miscellaneous Parameters
|
|
|
|
@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c prevent bad page break with this line
|
|
|
|
Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
|
|
@item PREDICATE_CODES
|
|
|
|
@findex PREDICATE_CODES
|
|
|
|
Define this if you have defined special-purpose predicates in the file
|
|
|
|
@file{@var{machine}.c}. This macro is called within an initializer of an
|
|
|
|
array of structures. The first field in the structure is the name of a
|
|
|
|
predicate and the second field is an array of rtl codes. For each
|
|
|
|
predicate, list all rtl codes that can be in expressions matched by the
|
|
|
|
predicate. The list should have a trailing comma. Here is an example
|
|
|
|
of two entries in the list for a typical RISC machine:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
#define PREDICATE_CODES \
|
|
|
|
@{"gen_reg_rtx_operand", @{SUBREG, REG@}@}, \
|
|
|
|
@{"reg_or_short_cint_operand", @{SUBREG, REG, CONST_INT@}@},
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Defining this macro does not affect the generated code (however,
|
|
|
|
incorrect definitions that omit an rtl code that may be matched by the
|
|
|
|
predicate can cause the compiler to malfunction). Instead, it allows
|
|
|
|
the table built by @file{genrecog} to be more compact and efficient,
|
|
|
|
thus speeding up the compiler. The most important predicates to include
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
in the list specified by this macro are those used in the most insn
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
patterns.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CASE_VECTOR_MODE
|
|
|
|
@item CASE_VECTOR_MODE
|
|
|
|
An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
|
|
|
|
elements of a jump-table should have.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE
|
|
|
|
@item CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
|
|
|
|
Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
|
|
|
|
when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
|
|
|
|
it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
|
|
|
|
To make this work, you also have to define INSN_ALIGN and
|
|
|
|
make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
|
|
|
|
The @var{body} argument is provided so that teh offset_unsigned and scale
|
|
|
|
flags can be updated.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
|
|
|
|
@item CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
|
|
|
|
should contain relative addresses. If jump-tables never contain
|
|
|
|
relative addresses, then you need not define this macro.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
|
|
|
|
@item CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
|
|
|
|
Define this if control falls through a @code{case} insn when the index
|
|
|
|
value is out of range. This means the specified default-label is
|
|
|
|
actually ignored by the @code{case} insn proper.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
|
|
|
|
@item CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
|
|
|
|
Define this to be the smallest number of different values for which it
|
|
|
|
is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
|
|
|
|
The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
|
|
|
|
five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
|
|
|
|
@item WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
|
|
|
|
smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
|
|
|
|
Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex LOAD_EXTEND_OP
|
|
|
|
@item LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mode})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
|
|
|
|
memory in @var{mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
|
|
|
|
bits outside of @var{mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
|
|
|
|
zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
|
|
|
|
of @var{mode} for which the
|
|
|
|
insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
|
|
|
|
@code{NIL} for other modes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This macro is not called with @var{mode} non-integral or with a width
|
|
|
|
greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
|
|
|
|
value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
|
|
|
|
@code{NIL}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
|
|
|
|
define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
|
|
|
|
@item SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
|
|
|
|
extends.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex IMPLICIT_FIX_EXPR
|
|
|
|
@item IMPLICIT_FIX_EXPR
|
|
|
|
An alias for a tree code that should be used by default for conversion
|
|
|
|
of floating point values to fixed point. Normally,
|
|
|
|
@code{FIX_ROUND_EXPR} is used.@refill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
|
|
|
|
@item FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
|
|
|
|
point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
|
|
|
|
unsigned one.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex EASY_DIV_EXPR
|
|
|
|
@item EASY_DIV_EXPR
|
|
|
|
An alias for a tree code that is the easiest kind of division to
|
|
|
|
compile code for in the general case. It may be
|
|
|
|
@code{TRUNC_DIV_EXPR}, @code{FLOOR_DIV_EXPR}, @code{CEIL_DIV_EXPR} or
|
|
|
|
@code{ROUND_DIV_EXPR}. These four division operators differ in how
|
|
|
|
they round the result to an integer. @code{EASY_DIV_EXPR} is used
|
|
|
|
when it is permissible to use any of those kinds of division and the
|
|
|
|
choice should be made on the basis of efficiency.@refill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MOVE_MAX
|
|
|
|
@item MOVE_MAX
|
|
|
|
The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MAX_MOVE_MAX
|
|
|
|
@item MAX_MOVE_MAX
|
|
|
|
The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
|
|
|
|
is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
|
|
|
|
constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
|
|
|
|
at run-time.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
|
|
|
|
@item SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
|
|
|
|
A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
|
|
|
|
actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
|
|
|
|
of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
|
|
|
|
this macro is non-zero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
|
|
|
|
a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
|
|
|
|
truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
|
|
|
|
instructions that act on bitfields at variable positions, which may
|
|
|
|
include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
|
|
|
|
also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
|
|
|
|
arguments to bitfield instructions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
|
|
|
|
position (for bitfield operations), or if no variable-position bitfield
|
|
|
|
instructions exist, you should define this macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
|
|
|
|
only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
|
|
|
|
bitfield operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
|
|
|
|
such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
|
|
|
|
the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION
|
|
|
|
@item TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
|
|
|
|
A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
|
|
|
|
``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
|
|
|
|
bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
|
|
|
|
operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
On many machines, this expression can be 1.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
|
|
|
|
@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
|
|
|
|
When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
|
|
|
|
modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
|
|
|
|
If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
|
|
|
|
such cases may improve things.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex STORE_FLAG_VALUE
|
|
|
|
@item STORE_FLAG_VALUE
|
|
|
|
A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
|
|
|
|
with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
|
|
|
|
(@samp{s@var{cond}}) when the condition is true. This description must
|
|
|
|
apply to @emph{all} the @samp{s@var{cond}} patterns and all the
|
|
|
|
comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A value of 1 or -1 means that the instruction implementing the
|
|
|
|
comparison operator returns exactly 1 or -1 when the comparison is true
|
|
|
|
and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
|
|
|
|
which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
|
|
|
|
true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
|
|
|
|
operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
|
|
|
|
@samp{s@var{cond}} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
|
|
|
|
@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
|
|
|
|
the compiler.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or -1, the compiler will
|
|
|
|
generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
|
|
|
|
replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
|
|
|
|
the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
|
|
|
|
For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
|
|
|
|
@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
|
|
|
|
@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
|
|
|
|
expression
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
|
|
can be converted to
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
|
|
where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
|
|
|
|
tested into the sign bit.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
|
|
|
|
for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
|
|
|
|
but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
|
|
|
|
are trying to port GNU CC to such a machine, include an instruction to
|
|
|
|
perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
|
|
|
|
comparison operators and let us know
|
|
|
|
@ifset USING
|
|
|
|
(@pxref{Bug Reporting,,How to Report Bugs}).
|
|
|
|
@end ifset
|
|
|
|
@ifclear USING
|
|
|
|
(@pxref{Bug Reporting,,How to Report Bugs,gcc.info,Using GCC}).
|
|
|
|
@end ifclear
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
|
|
|
|
from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
|
|
|
|
choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
|
|
|
|
to be used:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
|
|
|
|
@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
|
|
|
|
``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
|
|
|
|
comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
|
|
|
|
combine the normalization with other operations.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or -1, with -1 being
|
|
|
|
slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
|
|
|
|
other machines.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
|
|
|
|
exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
|
|
|
|
others.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
|
|
Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
|
|
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
|
|
|
|
@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
|
|
|
|
instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
|
|
|
|
those cases, e.g., one matching
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
|
|
(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
|
|
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
|
|
|
|
condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
|
|
|
|
@samp{s@var{cond}} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
|
|
|
|
machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
|
|
|
|
@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
|
|
|
|
find such instruction sequences on other machines.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
|
|
|
|
instructions.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
|
|
|
|
@item FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
|
|
|
|
A C expression that gives a non-zero floating point value that is
|
|
|
|
returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
|
|
|
|
Define this macro on machine that have comparison operations that return
|
|
|
|
floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
|
|
|
|
this macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex Pmode
|
|
|
|
@item Pmode
|
|
|
|
An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
|
|
|
|
this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
|
|
|
|
pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
|
|
|
|
On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
|
|
|
|
modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
|
|
|
|
@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
|
|
|
|
@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
|
|
|
|
to @code{Pmode}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex FUNCTION_MODE
|
|
|
|
@item FUNCTION_MODE
|
|
|
|
An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
|
|
|
|
being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most machines this
|
|
|
|
should be @code{QImode}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD
|
|
|
|
@item INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD (@var{decl})
|
|
|
|
A C expression for the maximum number of instructions above which the
|
|
|
|
function @var{decl} should not be inlined. @var{decl} is a
|
|
|
|
@code{FUNCTION_DECL} node.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The default definition of this macro is 64 plus 8 times the number of
|
|
|
|
arguments that the function accepts. Some people think a larger
|
|
|
|
threshold should be used on RISC machines.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SCCS_DIRECTIVE
|
|
|
|
@item SCCS_DIRECTIVE
|
|
|
|
Define this if the preprocessor should ignore @code{#sccs} directives
|
|
|
|
and print no error message.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
|
|
|
|
@item NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C.
|
|
|
|
This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
|
|
|
|
C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
|
|
|
|
@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex HANDLE_PRAGMA
|
|
|
|
@findex #pragma
|
|
|
|
@findex pragma
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@item HANDLE_PRAGMA (@var{stream}, @var{node})
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
Define this macro if you want to implement any pragmas. If defined, it
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
is a C expression whose value is 1 if the pragma was handled by the function.
|
|
|
|
The argument @var{stream} is the stdio input stream from which the source text
|
|
|
|
can be read. @var{node} is the tree node for the identifier after the
|
|
|
|
@code{#pragma}.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
It is generally a bad idea to implement new uses of @code{#pragma}. The
|
|
|
|
only reason to define this macro is for compatibility with other
|
|
|
|
compilers that do support @code{#pragma} for the sake of any user
|
|
|
|
programs which already use it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex VALID_MACHINE_DECL_ATTRIBUTE
|
|
|
|
@item VALID_MACHINE_DECL_ATTRIBUTE (@var{decl}, @var{attributes}, @var{identifier}, @var{args})
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is nonzero if @var{identifier} with
|
|
|
|
arguments @var{args} is a valid machine specific attribute for @var{decl}.
|
|
|
|
The attributes in @var{attributes} have previously been assigned to @var{decl}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex VALID_MACHINE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTE
|
|
|
|
@item VALID_MACHINE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTE (@var{type}, @var{attributes}, @var{identifier}, @var{args})
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is nonzero if @var{identifier} with
|
|
|
|
arguments @var{args} is a valid machine specific attribute for @var{type}.
|
|
|
|
The attributes in @var{attributes} have previously been assigned to @var{type}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
|
|
|
|
@item COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (@var{type1}, @var{type2})
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C expression whose value is zero if the attributes on
|
|
|
|
@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
|
|
|
|
and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
|
|
|
|
generated).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
|
|
|
|
@item SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (@var{type})
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C statement that assigns default attributes to
|
|
|
|
newly defined @var{type}.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex MERGE_MACHINE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
|
|
|
|
@item MERGE_MACHINE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (@var{type1}, @var{type2})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the merging of type attributes needs special handling.
|
|
|
|
If defined, the result is a list of the combined TYPE_ATTRIBUTES of
|
|
|
|
@var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed that comptypes has already been
|
|
|
|
called and returned 1.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MERGE_MACHINE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
|
|
|
|
@item MERGE_MACHINE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (@var{olddecl}, @var{newdecl})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the merging of decl attributes needs special handling.
|
|
|
|
If defined, the result is a list of the combined DECL_MACHINE_ATTRIBUTES of
|
|
|
|
@var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}. @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration
|
|
|
|
of @var{olddecl}. Examples of when this is needed are when one attribute
|
|
|
|
overrides another, or when an attribute is nullified by a subsequent
|
|
|
|
definition.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex SET_DEFAULT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
|
|
|
|
@item SET_DEFAULT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (@var{decl}, @var{attributes})
|
|
|
|
If defined, a C statement that assigns default attributes to
|
|
|
|
newly defined @var{decl}.
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
|
|
|
|
@item DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
|
|
|
|
Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in identifier
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
names. 0 means @samp{$} is not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
1 is the default; there is no need to define this macro in that case.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
This macro controls the compiler proper; it does not affect the preprocessor.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
|
|
|
|
@item NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
|
|
|
|
@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
|
|
|
|
G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
|
|
|
|
@samp{.} is used instead.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
|
|
|
|
@item NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
|
|
|
|
@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
|
|
|
|
have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
|
|
|
|
are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
|
|
|
|
@item DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if the target system expects every program's @code{main}
|
|
|
|
function to return a standard ``success'' value by default (if no other
|
|
|
|
value is explicitly returned).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The definition should be a C statement (sans semicolon) to generate the
|
|
|
|
appropriate rtl instructions. It is used only when compiling the end of
|
|
|
|
@code{main}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item HAVE_ATEXIT
|
|
|
|
@findex HAVE_ATEXIT
|
|
|
|
Define this if the target system supports the function
|
|
|
|
@code{atexit} from the ANSI C standard. If this is not defined,
|
|
|
|
and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} is not defined, a default
|
|
|
|
@code{exit} function will be provided to support C++.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@item EXIT_BODY
|
|
|
|
@findex EXIT_BODY
|
|
|
|
Define this if your @code{exit} function needs to do something
|
|
|
|
besides calling an external function @code{_cleanup} before
|
|
|
|
terminating with @code{_exit}. The @code{EXIT_BODY} macro is
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
only needed if neither @code{HAVE_ATEXIT} nor
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} are defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED
|
|
|
|
@item INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
|
|
|
|
delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
|
|
|
|
even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GNU CC knows that
|
|
|
|
every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
|
|
|
|
or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
you should define this macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED
|
|
|
|
@item INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
|
|
|
|
delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
|
|
|
|
some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
|
|
|
|
are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
|
|
|
|
instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
slot of @var{insn}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
|
|
|
|
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@findex MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
|
|
|
|
@item MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (@var{insn})
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
In rare cases, correct code generation requires extra machine
|
|
|
|
dependent processing between the second jump optimization pass and
|
|
|
|
delayed branch scheduling. On those machines, define this macro as a C
|
|
|
|
statement to act on the code starting at @var{insn}.
|
1999-08-26 09:30:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
|
|
|
|
@item MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
|
|
|
|
Define this macro if in some cases global symbols from one translation
|
|
|
|
unit may not be bound to undefined symbols in another translation unit
|
|
|
|
without user intervention. For instance, under Microsoft Windows
|
|
|
|
symbols must be explicitly imported from shared libraries (DLLs).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex GIV_SORT_CRITERION
|
|
|
|
@item GIV_SORT_CRITERION (@var{giv1}, @var{giv2})
|
|
|
|
In some cases, the strength reduction optimization pass can produce better
|
|
|
|
code if this is defined. This macro controls the order that induction
|
|
|
|
variables are combined. This macro is particularly useful if the target has
|
|
|
|
limited addressing modes. For instance, the SH target has only positive
|
|
|
|
offsets in addresses. Thus sorting to put the smallest address first
|
|
|
|
allows the most combinations to be found.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex ISSUE_RATE
|
|
|
|
@item ISSUE_RATE
|
|
|
|
A C expression that returns how many instructions can be issued at the
|
|
|
|
same time if the machine is a superscalar machine. This is only used by
|
|
|
|
the @samp{Haifa} scheduler, and not the traditional scheduler.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MD_SCHED_INIT
|
|
|
|
@item MD_SCHED_INIT (@var{file}, @var{verbose}
|
|
|
|
A C statement which is executed by the @samp{Haifa} scheduler at the
|
|
|
|
beginning of each block of instructions that are to be scheduled.
|
|
|
|
@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
|
|
|
|
debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
|
|
|
|
@samp{-fsched-verbose-}@var{n}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MD_SCHED_REORDER
|
|
|
|
@item MD_SCHED_REORDER (@var{file}, @var{verbose}, @var{ready}, @var{n_ready})
|
|
|
|
A C statement which is executed by the @samp{Haifa} scheduler after it
|
|
|
|
has scheduled the ready list to allow the machine description to reorder
|
|
|
|
it (for example to combine two small instructions together on
|
|
|
|
@samp{VLIW} machines). @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio
|
|
|
|
stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level
|
|
|
|
provided by @samp{-fsched-verbose-}@var{n}. @var{ready} is a pointer to
|
|
|
|
the ready list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled.
|
|
|
|
@var{n_ready} is the number of elements in the ready list. The
|
|
|
|
scheduler reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
|
|
|
|
@var{ready}[@var{n_ready}-1] and going to @var{ready}[0].
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MD_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
|
|
|
|
@item MD_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (@var{file}, @var{verbose}, @var{insn}, @var{more})
|
|
|
|
A C statement which is executed by the @samp{Haifa} scheduler after it
|
|
|
|
has scheduled an insn from the ready list. @var{file} is either a null
|
|
|
|
pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
|
|
|
|
is the verbose level provided by @samp{-fsched-verbose-}@var{n}.
|
|
|
|
@var{insn} is the instruction that was scheduled. @var{more} is the
|
|
|
|
number of instructions that can be issued in the current cycle. The
|
|
|
|
@samp{MD_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE} macro is responsible for updating the
|
|
|
|
value of @var{more} (typically by @var{more}--).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
|
|
|
|
@item MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
|
|
|
|
Define this to the largest integer machine mode which can be used for
|
|
|
|
operations other than load, store and copy operations.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need only define this macro if the target holds values larger than
|
|
|
|
@code{word_mode} in general purpose registers. Most targets should not define
|
|
|
|
this macro.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@findex NEED_MATH_LIBRARY
|
|
|
|
@item NEED_MATH_LIBRARY
|
|
|
|
Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if @code{g++} should
|
|
|
|
automatically link in the math library or to zero if @code{g++} should not
|
|
|
|
automatically link in the math library.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You need only define this macro if the target does not always need the math
|
|
|
|
library linked into C++ programs.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
@end table
|